elf32-ppc.c revision 1.11 1 1.1 christos /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 1.11 christos Copyright (C) 1994-2024 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 1.1 christos Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4 1.1 christos
5 1.1 christos This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 1.1 christos
7 1.1 christos This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 1.1 christos it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 1.1 christos the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 1.1 christos (at your option) any later version.
11 1.1 christos
12 1.1 christos This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 1.1 christos but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 1.1 christos MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 1.1 christos GNU General Public License for more details.
16 1.1 christos
17 1.1 christos You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 1.1 christos along with this program; if not, write to the
19 1.1 christos Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 1.1 christos Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21 1.1 christos
22 1.10 christos /* The assembler should generate a full set of section symbols even
23 1.10 christos when they appear unused. The linux kernel build tool recordmcount
24 1.10 christos needs them. */
25 1.10 christos #define TARGET_KEEP_UNUSED_SECTION_SYMBOLS true
26 1.1 christos
27 1.1 christos #include "sysdep.h"
28 1.1 christos #include <stdarg.h>
29 1.1 christos #include "bfd.h"
30 1.1 christos #include "bfdlink.h"
31 1.1 christos #include "libbfd.h"
32 1.1 christos #include "elf-bfd.h"
33 1.1 christos #include "elf/ppc.h"
34 1.1 christos #include "elf32-ppc.h"
35 1.1 christos #include "elf-vxworks.h"
36 1.1 christos #include "dwarf2.h"
37 1.7 christos #include "opcode/ppc.h"
38 1.1 christos
39 1.9 christos /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
40 1.9 christos #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
41 1.9 christos
42 1.1 christos typedef enum split16_format_type
43 1.1 christos {
44 1.1 christos split16a_type = 0,
45 1.1 christos split16d_type
46 1.1 christos }
47 1.1 christos split16_format_type;
48 1.1 christos
49 1.1 christos /* RELA relocations are used here. */
50 1.1 christos
51 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
52 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
54 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
55 1.1 christos
56 1.1 christos /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
57 1.1 christos #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
58 1.1 christos /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
59 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
60 1.1 christos /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
61 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
62 1.1 christos
63 1.1 christos /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
64 1.1 christos section. */
65 1.1 christos #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
66 1.1 christos
67 1.1 christos /* For old-style PLT. */
68 1.1 christos /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
69 1.1 christos #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
70 1.1 christos
71 1.1 christos /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
72 1.1 christos #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
73 1.7 christos #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
74 1.7 christos ((4*4 \
75 1.7 christos + (h != NULL \
76 1.7 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
77 1.7 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
78 1.7 christos + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
79 1.7 christos & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
80 1.1 christos
81 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
82 1.1 christos
83 1.1 christos /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
84 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
85 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
86 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
87 1.1 christos {
88 1.7 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
89 1.7 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
90 1.7 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
91 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
92 1.7 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
93 1.7 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
94 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
95 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
96 1.1 christos };
97 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
98 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
99 1.1 christos {
100 1.1 christos 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
101 1.1 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
102 1.1 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
103 1.1 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
104 1.1 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
105 1.1 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
106 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
107 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
108 1.1 christos };
109 1.1 christos
110 1.1 christos /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
111 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
112 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
113 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
114 1.1 christos {
115 1.7 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
116 1.7 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
117 1.7 christos 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
118 1.7 christos 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
119 1.7 christos 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
120 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
121 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
122 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
123 1.1 christos };
124 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
125 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
126 1.1 christos {
127 1.1 christos 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
128 1.7 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
129 1.1 christos 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
130 1.7 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
131 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
134 1.7 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
135 1.1 christos };
136 1.1 christos
137 1.1 christos /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
138 1.1 christos .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
139 1.1 christos
140 1.1 christos /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
141 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
142 1.1 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
143 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
144 1.7 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
145 1.1 christos a shared library. */
146 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
147 1.1 christos
148 1.1 christos /* Some instructions. */
149 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
150 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
151 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
152 1.1 christos #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
153 1.1 christos #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
154 1.1 christos #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
155 1.1 christos #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
156 1.1 christos #define B 0x48000000
157 1.3 christos #define BA 0x48000002
158 1.1 christos #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
159 1.1 christos #define BCTR 0x4e800420
160 1.1 christos #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
161 1.1 christos #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
162 1.1 christos #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
163 1.1 christos #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
164 1.1 christos #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
165 1.1 christos #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
166 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
167 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
168 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
169 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
170 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
171 1.1 christos #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
172 1.1 christos #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
173 1.1 christos #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
174 1.1 christos #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
175 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
176 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
177 1.1 christos #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
178 1.1 christos #define NOP 0x60000000
179 1.1 christos #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
180 1.1 christos
181 1.1 christos /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
182 1.1 christos #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
183 1.1 christos #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
184 1.1 christos
185 1.1 christos /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
186 1.1 christos #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
187 1.1 christos ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
188 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
189 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
190 1.1 christos
191 1.9 christos /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
193 1.9 christos /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
194 1.9 christos field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
195 1.9 christos always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
196 1.9 christos PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
197 1.9 christos the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
198 1.9 christos and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
199 1.9 christos rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
200 1.9 christos #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
201 1.9 christos complain, special_func) \
202 1.9 christos HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
203 1.10 christos complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
204 1.9 christos #type, false, 0, mask, pc_relative)
205 1.1 christos
206 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
207 1.1 christos
208 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
209 1.10 christos /* This reloc does nothing. */
210 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
211 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
212 1.1 christos
213 1.10 christos /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
214 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
215 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
216 1.1 christos
217 1.1 christos /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
218 1.10 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
219 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, false, signed,
220 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
221 1.1 christos
222 1.10 christos /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
223 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
224 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
225 1.1 christos
226 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
227 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
228 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
229 1.1 christos
230 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
231 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
232 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
233 1.1 christos
234 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
235 1.10 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
236 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
237 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
238 1.1 christos
239 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
240 1.10 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
241 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
242 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
243 1.1 christos
244 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
245 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
246 1.10 christos bits must be zero. */
247 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
248 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
249 1.1 christos
250 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
251 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
252 1.10 christos two bits must be zero. */
253 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
254 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
255 1.1 christos
256 1.10 christos /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
257 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
258 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
259 1.1 christos
260 1.10 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
261 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
262 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
263 1.1 christos
264 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
265 1.1 christos the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
266 1.10 christos zero. */
267 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
268 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
269 1.1 christos
270 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
271 1.1 christos the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
272 1.10 christos be zero. */
273 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
274 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
275 1.1 christos
276 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
277 1.10 christos symbol. */
278 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
279 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
280 1.1 christos
281 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
282 1.10 christos the symbol. */
283 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
284 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
285 1.1 christos
286 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
287 1.10 christos the symbol. */
288 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
289 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
290 1.1 christos
291 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
292 1.10 christos the symbol. */
293 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
294 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
295 1.1 christos
296 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
297 1.10 christos entry for the symbol. */
298 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
299 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
300 1.1 christos
301 1.1 christos /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
302 1.1 christos both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
303 1.1 christos dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
304 1.1 christos shared library into the object, because the object being
305 1.10 christos run has to have the data at some particular address. */
306 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
307 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
308 1.1 christos
309 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
310 1.10 christos entries. */
311 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
312 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
313 1.1 christos
314 1.10 christos /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
315 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
316 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
317 1.1 christos
318 1.1 christos /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
319 1.1 christos longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
320 1.10 christos addend. */
321 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
322 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
323 1.1 christos
324 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
325 1.1 christos object rather than the final value. Normally used for
326 1.10 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
327 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
328 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
329 1.1 christos
330 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
331 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
332 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
333 1.1 christos
334 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
335 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
336 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
337 1.1 christos
338 1.10 christos /* 32-bit PC relative */
339 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, dont,
340 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
341 1.1 christos
342 1.1 christos /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
343 1.10 christos FIXME: not supported. */
344 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
345 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
346 1.1 christos
347 1.1 christos /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
348 1.10 christos FIXME: not supported. */
349 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 4, 32, 0, 0, true, dont,
350 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
351 1.1 christos
352 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
353 1.10 christos the symbol. */
354 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
355 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
356 1.1 christos
357 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
358 1.10 christos the symbol. */
359 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
360 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
361 1.1 christos
362 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
363 1.10 christos the symbol. */
364 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
365 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
366 1.1 christos
367 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
368 1.10 christos small data items. */
369 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
370 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
371 1.1 christos
372 1.10 christos /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
373 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
374 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
375 1.1 christos
376 1.10 christos /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
377 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
378 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
379 1.1 christos
380 1.10 christos /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
381 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
382 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
383 1.1 christos
384 1.10 christos /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
385 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
386 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
387 1.1 christos
388 1.10 christos /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
389 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
390 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391 1.10 christos
392 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
393 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394 1.10 christos
395 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
396 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
397 1.7 christos
398 1.10 christos /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
399 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
400 1.9 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401 1.10 christos
402 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
403 1.7 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
404 1.1 christos
405 1.1 christos /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
406 1.10 christos definition of its TLS sym. */
407 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
408 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
409 1.1 christos
410 1.1 christos /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
411 1.1 christos of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
412 1.10 christos contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
413 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
414 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
415 1.1 christos
416 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
417 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
418 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
419 1.1 christos
420 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
421 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
422 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
423 1.1 christos
424 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
425 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
426 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
427 1.1 christos
428 1.10 christos /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
429 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
430 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
431 1.1 christos
432 1.1 christos /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
433 1.10 christos sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
434 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
435 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
436 1.1 christos
437 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
438 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
439 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
440 1.1 christos
441 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
442 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
443 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
444 1.1 christos
445 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
446 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
447 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
448 1.1 christos
449 1.10 christos /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
450 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
451 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
452 1.1 christos
453 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
454 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
455 1.10 christos to the first entry. */
456 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
457 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
458 1.1 christos
459 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
460 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
461 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
462 1.1 christos
463 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
464 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
465 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
466 1.1 christos
467 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
468 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
469 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
470 1.1 christos
471 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
472 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
473 1.10 christos first entry. */
474 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
475 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
476 1.1 christos
477 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
478 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
479 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
480 1.1 christos
481 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
482 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
483 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
484 1.1 christos
485 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
486 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
487 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
488 1.1 christos
489 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
490 1.10 christos the offset to the entry. */
491 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
492 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
493 1.1 christos
494 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
495 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
496 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
497 1.1 christos
498 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
499 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
500 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
501 1.1 christos
502 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
503 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
504 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
505 1.1 christos
506 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
507 1.10 christos offset to the entry. */
508 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
509 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
510 1.1 christos
511 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
512 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
513 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
514 1.1 christos
515 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
516 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
517 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
518 1.1 christos
519 1.10 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
520 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
521 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
522 1.1 christos
523 1.1 christos /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
524 1.1 christos in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
525 1.1 christos
526 1.10 christos /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
527 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
528 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
529 1.1 christos
530 1.10 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
531 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
532 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
533 1.1 christos
534 1.10 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
535 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
536 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
537 1.1 christos
538 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
539 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
540 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
541 1.1 christos
542 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
543 1.1 christos plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
544 1.10 christos is negative. */
545 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
546 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
547 1.1 christos
548 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
549 1.1 christos address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
550 1.10 christos _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
551 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
552 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
553 1.1 christos
554 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
555 1.1 christos address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
556 1.10 christos _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
557 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
558 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
559 1.1 christos
560 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
561 1.10 christos small data items. */
562 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
563 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
564 1.1 christos
565 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
566 1.1 christos signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
567 1.10 christos field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
568 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
569 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
570 1.1 christos
571 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
572 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
573 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
574 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
575 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
576 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
577 1.1 christos
578 1.1 christos /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
579 1.1 christos in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
580 1.10 christos register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
581 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
582 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
583 1.1 christos
584 1.10 christos /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
585 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 2, 8, 0xff, 1, true, signed,
586 1.3 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
587 1.1 christos
588 1.10 christos /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
589 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 4, 16, 0xfffe, 0, true, signed,
590 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
591 1.3 christos
592 1.10 christos /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
593 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 4, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, true, signed,
594 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
595 1.1 christos
596 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
597 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
598 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
599 1.1 christos
600 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
601 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
602 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
603 1.1 christos
604 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
605 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
606 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
607 1.1 christos
608 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
609 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
610 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
611 1.1 christos
612 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
613 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
614 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
615 1.1 christos
616 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
617 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
618 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
619 1.3 christos
620 1.3 christos /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
621 1.3 christos instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
622 1.10 christos the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
623 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
624 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
625 1.3 christos
626 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
627 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
628 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
629 1.1 christos
630 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
631 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
632 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
633 1.1 christos
634 1.10 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
635 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
636 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
637 1.1 christos
638 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
639 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
640 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
641 1.1 christos
642 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
643 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
644 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
645 1.1 christos
646 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
647 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
648 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
649 1.1 christos
650 1.10 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
651 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
652 1.7 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
653 1.7 christos
654 1.10 christos /* e_li split20 format. */
655 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 4, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, false, dont,
656 1.9 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657 1.10 christos
658 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
659 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
660 1.1 christos
661 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
662 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, signed,
663 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
664 1.1 christos
665 1.10 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
666 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, dont,
667 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
668 1.1 christos
669 1.10 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
670 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
671 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
672 1.1 christos
673 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
674 1.10 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
675 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
676 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
677 1.3 christos
678 1.10 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
679 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, true, signed,
680 1.3 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
681 1.7 christos
682 1.10 christos /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
683 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, false, signed,
684 1.7 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
685 1.1 christos
686 1.10 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
687 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
688 1.1 christos NULL),
689 1.1 christos
690 1.10 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
691 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
692 1.1 christos NULL),
693 1.1 christos
694 1.10 christos /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
695 1.9 christos HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
696 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
697 1.1 christos };
698 1.1 christos
699 1.1 christos /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
701 1.1 christos
702 1.1 christos static void
703 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
704 1.1 christos {
705 1.1 christos unsigned int i, type;
706 1.1 christos
707 1.1 christos for (i = 0;
708 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
709 1.1 christos i++)
710 1.1 christos {
711 1.1 christos type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
712 1.1 christos if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
713 1.1 christos / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
714 1.1 christos abort ();
715 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
716 1.1 christos }
717 1.1 christos }
718 1.1 christos
719 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *
720 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
721 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
722 1.1 christos {
723 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
724 1.1 christos
725 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
726 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
727 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
728 1.1 christos
729 1.1 christos switch (code)
730 1.1 christos {
731 1.1 christos default:
732 1.1 christos return NULL;
733 1.1 christos
734 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
735 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
736 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
737 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
738 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
739 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
740 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
741 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
742 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
743 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
744 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
747 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
748 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
749 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
750 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
751 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
752 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
753 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
754 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
755 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
756 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
757 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
758 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
759 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
760 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
761 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
762 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
763 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
764 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
765 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
766 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
767 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
768 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
769 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
770 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
771 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
772 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
773 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
774 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
775 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
776 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
777 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
778 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
779 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
780 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
781 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
782 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
783 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
784 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
785 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
786 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
787 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
788 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
789 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
790 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
791 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
792 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
793 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
794 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
795 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
796 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
797 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
798 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
799 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
800 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
801 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
802 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
803 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
804 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
805 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
806 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
807 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
808 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
809 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
810 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
811 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
812 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
813 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
814 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
815 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
816 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
817 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
818 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
819 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
820 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
821 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
822 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
823 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
824 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
825 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
826 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
827 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
828 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
829 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
830 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
831 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
832 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
833 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
834 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
835 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
836 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
837 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
838 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
839 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
840 1.1 christos break;
841 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
842 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
843 1.1 christos break;
844 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
845 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
846 1.1 christos break;
847 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
848 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
849 1.1 christos break;
850 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
851 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
852 1.1 christos break;
853 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
854 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
855 1.1 christos break;
856 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
857 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
858 1.7 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
859 1.3 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
860 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
861 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
862 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
863 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
864 1.1 christos }
865 1.1 christos
866 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
867 1.1 christos };
868 1.1 christos
869 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *
870 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
871 1.1 christos const char *r_name)
872 1.1 christos {
873 1.1 christos unsigned int i;
874 1.1 christos
875 1.1 christos for (i = 0;
876 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
877 1.1 christos i++)
878 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
879 1.1 christos && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
880 1.1 christos return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
881 1.1 christos
882 1.1 christos return NULL;
883 1.1 christos }
884 1.1 christos
885 1.10 christos /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
886 1.7 christos
887 1.1 christos static bool
888 1.1 christos ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
889 1.1 christos arelent *cache_ptr,
890 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
891 1.3 christos {
892 1.1 christos unsigned int r_type;
893 1.1 christos
894 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
895 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
896 1.3 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
897 1.3 christos
898 1.3 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
899 1.7 christos if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
900 1.7 christos {
901 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
902 1.3 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
903 1.10 christos abfd, r_type);
904 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
905 1.7 christos return false;
906 1.3 christos }
907 1.1 christos
908 1.1 christos cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
909 1.1 christos
910 1.7 christos /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
911 1.1 christos ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
912 1.7 christos if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
913 1.7 christos {
914 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
915 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
916 1.1 christos abfd, r_type);
917 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
918 1.1 christos
919 1.7 christos return false;
920 1.10 christos }
921 1.1 christos
922 1.1 christos return true;
923 1.1 christos }
924 1.1 christos
925 1.1 christos /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
926 1.7 christos
927 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
928 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
929 1.7 christos arelent *reloc_entry,
930 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol,
931 1.1 christos void *data,
932 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
933 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd,
934 1.3 christos char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
935 1.3 christos {
936 1.3 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
937 1.3 christos long insn;
938 1.1 christos bfd_size_type octets;
939 1.1 christos bfd_vma value;
940 1.1 christos
941 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL)
942 1.1 christos {
943 1.1 christos reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
944 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
945 1.3 christos }
946 1.3 christos
947 1.3 christos reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
948 1.3 christos r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
949 1.3 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
950 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_continue;
951 1.3 christos
952 1.3 christos value = 0;
953 1.3 christos if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
954 1.3 christos value = symbol->value;
955 1.3 christos value += (reloc_entry->addend
956 1.3 christos + symbol->section->output_offset
957 1.3 christos + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
958 1.3 christos value -= (reloc_entry->address
959 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset
960 1.3 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
961 1.9 christos value >>= 16;
962 1.10 christos
963 1.10 christos octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
964 1.10 christos if (!bfd_reloc_offset_in_range (reloc_entry->howto, abfd,
965 1.10 christos input_section, octets))
966 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
967 1.3 christos
968 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
969 1.3 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
970 1.3 christos insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
971 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
972 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
973 1.1 christos }
974 1.1 christos
975 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
976 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
977 1.1 christos arelent *reloc_entry,
978 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol,
979 1.1 christos void *data,
980 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
981 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd,
982 1.1 christos char **error_message)
983 1.1 christos {
984 1.1 christos /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
985 1.1 christos call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
986 1.1 christos link time. */
987 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL)
988 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
989 1.1 christos input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
990 1.11 christos
991 1.11 christos if (error_message != NULL)
992 1.1 christos *error_message = bfd_asprintf (_("generic linker can't handle %s"),
993 1.1 christos reloc_entry->howto->name);
994 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
995 1.1 christos }
996 1.1 christos
997 1.1 christos /* Sections created by the linker. */
999 1.1 christos
1000 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section
1001 1.1 christos {
1002 1.1 christos /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
1003 1.1 christos asection *section;
1004 1.1 christos /* Section name. */
1005 1.1 christos const char *name;
1006 1.1 christos /* Associated bss section name. */
1007 1.1 christos const char *bss_name;
1008 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol name. */
1009 1.1 christos const char *sym_name;
1010 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol. */
1011 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1012 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_t;
1013 1.1 christos
1014 1.1 christos /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1015 1.1 christos symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1016 1.1 christos based on different addend's. */
1017 1.1 christos
1018 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1019 1.1 christos {
1020 1.1 christos /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1021 1.1 christos struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1022 1.1 christos /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1023 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
1024 1.1 christos /* addend used */
1025 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
1026 1.1 christos /* which linker section this is */
1027 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1028 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1029 1.1 christos
1030 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1031 1.1 christos {
1032 1.1 christos struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1033 1.1 christos
1034 1.1 christos /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1035 1.1 christos sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1036 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1037 1.1 christos
1038 1.1 christos /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1039 1.1 christos unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1040 1.1 christos unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1041 1.1 christos };
1042 1.1 christos
1043 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1044 1.1 christos ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1045 1.1 christos
1046 1.1 christos #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1047 1.1 christos (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1048 1.1 christos
1049 1.1 christos #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1050 1.1 christos (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1051 1.1 christos && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1052 1.10 christos
1053 1.1 christos /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1054 1.1 christos
1055 1.1 christos static bool
1056 1.1 christos ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1057 1.1 christos {
1058 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1059 1.6 christos PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1060 1.6 christos }
1061 1.10 christos
1062 1.6 christos /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1063 1.6 christos
1064 1.6 christos bool
1065 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1066 1.6 christos {
1067 1.6 christos unsigned long mach = 0;
1068 1.6 christos asection *s;
1069 1.6 christos unsigned char *contents;
1070 1.6 christos
1071 1.6 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1072 1.6 christos && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1073 1.6 christos {
1074 1.6 christos
1075 1.6 christos for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1076 1.6 christos if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1077 1.6 christos break;
1078 1.6 christos if (s != NULL)
1079 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1080 1.6 christos }
1081 1.6 christos
1082 1.9 christos if (mach == 0)
1083 1.9 christos {
1084 1.11 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1085 1.9 christos if (s != NULL
1086 1.6 christos && s->size >= 24
1087 1.6 christos && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0
1088 1.6 christos && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1089 1.6 christos {
1090 1.6 christos unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1091 1.6 christos unsigned int i;
1092 1.6 christos
1093 1.6 christos for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1094 1.6 christos {
1095 1.6 christos unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1096 1.6 christos switch (val >> 16)
1097 1.6 christos {
1098 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1099 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1100 1.6 christos if (mach == 0)
1101 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1102 1.6 christos break;
1103 1.6 christos
1104 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1105 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1106 1.6 christos if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1107 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1108 1.6 christos break;
1109 1.6 christos
1110 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1111 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1112 1.7 christos case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1113 1.6 christos if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1114 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1115 1.6 christos break;
1116 1.6 christos
1117 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1118 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1119 1.6 christos break;
1120 1.6 christos
1121 1.6 christos default:
1122 1.6 christos mach = -1ul;
1123 1.6 christos }
1124 1.6 christos }
1125 1.6 christos free (contents);
1126 1.6 christos }
1127 1.6 christos }
1128 1.6 christos
1129 1.6 christos if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1130 1.6 christos {
1131 1.6 christos const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1132 1.6 christos
1133 1.6 christos for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1134 1.6 christos if (arch->mach == mach)
1135 1.6 christos {
1136 1.6 christos abfd->arch_info = arch;
1137 1.10 christos break;
1138 1.6 christos }
1139 1.6 christos }
1140 1.1 christos return true;
1141 1.6 christos }
1142 1.1 christos
1143 1.10 christos /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1144 1.1 christos default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1145 1.1 christos
1146 1.6 christos static bool
1147 1.10 christos ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1148 1.6 christos {
1149 1.6 christos if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1150 1.1 christos return true;
1151 1.1 christos
1152 1.1 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1153 1.1 christos {
1154 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1155 1.1 christos
1156 1.1 christos if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1157 1.1 christos {
1158 1.1 christos /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1159 1.1 christos abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1160 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1161 1.1 christos }
1162 1.1 christos }
1163 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1164 1.1 christos }
1165 1.10 christos
1166 1.1 christos /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1167 1.1 christos
1168 1.1 christos static bool
1169 1.1 christos ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1170 1.1 christos {
1171 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1172 1.10 christos || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1173 1.10 christos
1174 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1175 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (abfd) = true;
1176 1.1 christos return true;
1177 1.1 christos }
1178 1.10 christos
1179 1.1 christos /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1180 1.1 christos
1181 1.1 christos static bool
1182 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1183 1.1 christos {
1184 1.1 christos int offset;
1185 1.1 christos unsigned int size;
1186 1.1 christos
1187 1.10 christos switch (note->descsz)
1188 1.1 christos {
1189 1.1 christos default:
1190 1.1 christos return false;
1191 1.3 christos
1192 1.1 christos case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1193 1.1 christos /* pr_cursig */
1194 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1195 1.1 christos
1196 1.1 christos /* pr_pid */
1197 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1198 1.1 christos
1199 1.1 christos /* pr_reg */
1200 1.1 christos offset = 72;
1201 1.1 christos size = 192;
1202 1.1 christos
1203 1.1 christos break;
1204 1.1 christos }
1205 1.1 christos
1206 1.1 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1207 1.1 christos return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1208 1.10 christos size, note->descpos + offset);
1209 1.1 christos }
1210 1.1 christos
1211 1.1 christos static bool
1212 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1213 1.1 christos {
1214 1.10 christos switch (note->descsz)
1215 1.1 christos {
1216 1.1 christos default:
1217 1.3 christos return false;
1218 1.1 christos
1219 1.3 christos case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1220 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1221 1.3 christos = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1222 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1223 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1224 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1225 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1226 1.1 christos }
1227 1.1 christos
1228 1.1 christos /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1229 1.1 christos onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1230 1.3 christos implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1231 1.1 christos
1232 1.1 christos {
1233 1.1 christos char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1234 1.1 christos int n = strlen (command);
1235 1.1 christos
1236 1.1 christos if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1237 1.10 christos command[n - 1] = '\0';
1238 1.1 christos }
1239 1.1 christos
1240 1.1 christos return true;
1241 1.1 christos }
1242 1.1 christos
1243 1.1 christos static char *
1244 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1245 1.1 christos {
1246 1.1 christos switch (note_type)
1247 1.1 christos {
1248 1.1 christos default:
1249 1.1 christos return NULL;
1250 1.7 christos
1251 1.1 christos case NT_PRPSINFO:
1252 1.1 christos {
1253 1.1 christos char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1254 1.1 christos va_list ap;
1255 1.1 christos
1256 1.9 christos va_start (ap, note_type);
1257 1.7 christos memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1258 1.9 christos strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1259 1.7 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1260 1.7 christos DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1261 1.7 christos /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1262 1.7 christos -Wstringop-truncation:
1263 1.7 christos https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1264 1.1 christos */
1265 1.9 christos DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1266 1.7 christos #endif
1267 1.7 christos strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1268 1.1 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1269 1.1 christos DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1270 1.1 christos #endif
1271 1.1 christos va_end (ap);
1272 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1273 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1274 1.1 christos }
1275 1.1 christos
1276 1.1 christos case NT_PRSTATUS:
1277 1.1 christos {
1278 1.1 christos char data[268];
1279 1.1 christos va_list ap;
1280 1.1 christos long pid;
1281 1.1 christos int cursig;
1282 1.1 christos const void *greg;
1283 1.1 christos
1284 1.1 christos va_start (ap, note_type);
1285 1.1 christos memset (data, 0, 72);
1286 1.1 christos pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1287 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1288 1.1 christos cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1289 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1290 1.1 christos greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1291 1.1 christos memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1292 1.1 christos memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1293 1.1 christos va_end (ap);
1294 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1295 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1296 1.1 christos }
1297 1.1 christos }
1298 1.3 christos }
1299 1.1 christos
1300 1.1 christos static flagword
1301 1.1 christos ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1302 1.1 christos {
1303 1.1 christos
1304 1.1 christos if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1305 1.1 christos return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1306 1.1 christos
1307 1.1 christos return 0;
1308 1.1 christos }
1309 1.1 christos
1310 1.1 christos /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1311 1.1 christos or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1312 1.1 christos
1313 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
1314 1.1 christos ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1315 1.1 christos const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1316 1.1 christos const arelent *rel)
1317 1.1 christos {
1318 1.1 christos return rel->address;
1319 1.1 christos }
1320 1.1 christos
1321 1.1 christos /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1322 1.10 christos is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1323 1.1 christos type. */
1324 1.1 christos
1325 1.1 christos static bool
1326 1.1 christos ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1327 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1328 1.1 christos const char *name,
1329 1.1 christos int shindex)
1330 1.1 christos {
1331 1.1 christos asection *newsect;
1332 1.10 christos flagword flags;
1333 1.1 christos
1334 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1335 1.10 christos return false;
1336 1.1 christos
1337 1.1 christos newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1338 1.1 christos flags = 0;
1339 1.1 christos if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1340 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1341 1.1 christos
1342 1.10 christos if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1343 1.10 christos flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1344 1.10 christos
1345 1.10 christos if (startswith (name, ".PPC.EMB"))
1346 1.10 christos name += 8;
1347 1.10 christos if (startswith (name, ".sbss")
1348 1.10 christos || startswith (name, ".sdata"))
1349 1.10 christos flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
1350 1.1 christos
1351 1.1 christos return (flags == 0
1352 1.1 christos || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
1353 1.1 christos }
1354 1.10 christos
1355 1.1 christos /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1356 1.1 christos
1357 1.1 christos static bool
1358 1.1 christos ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1359 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1360 1.1 christos asection *asect)
1361 1.1 christos {
1362 1.10 christos if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1363 1.1 christos shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1364 1.1 christos
1365 1.1 christos return true;
1366 1.1 christos }
1367 1.1 christos
1368 1.1 christos /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1369 1.1 christos need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1370 1.1 christos
1371 1.1 christos static int
1372 1.1 christos ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1373 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1374 1.1 christos {
1375 1.1 christos asection *s;
1376 1.1 christos int ret = 0;
1377 1.1 christos
1378 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1379 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1380 1.1 christos ++ret;
1381 1.1 christos
1382 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1383 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1384 1.1 christos ++ret;
1385 1.1 christos
1386 1.3 christos return ret;
1387 1.1 christos }
1388 1.10 christos
1389 1.1 christos /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1390 1.1 christos
1391 1.1 christos bool
1392 1.7 christos ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1393 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1394 1.1 christos {
1395 1.1 christos struct elf_segment_map *m;
1396 1.1 christos
1397 1.1 christos /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1398 1.1 christos LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1399 1.1 christos there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1400 1.3 christos If we find that case, we split the segment.
1401 1.1 christos We maintain the original output section order. */
1402 1.7 christos
1403 1.10 christos for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1404 1.7 christos {
1405 1.7 christos struct elf_segment_map *n;
1406 1.7 christos size_t amt;
1407 1.7 christos unsigned int j, k;
1408 1.1 christos unsigned int p_flags;
1409 1.1 christos
1410 1.7 christos if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1411 1.1 christos continue;
1412 1.7 christos
1413 1.7 christos for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1414 1.7 christos {
1415 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1416 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_W;
1417 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1418 1.7 christos {
1419 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_X;
1420 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1421 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1422 1.7 christos break;
1423 1.7 christos }
1424 1.7 christos }
1425 1.7 christos if (j != m->count)
1426 1.1 christos while (++j != m->count)
1427 1.7 christos {
1428 1.7 christos unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1429 1.7 christos
1430 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1431 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1432 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1433 1.7 christos {
1434 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1435 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1436 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1437 1.7 christos if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1438 1.7 christos break;
1439 1.7 christos }
1440 1.7 christos p_flags |= p_flags1;
1441 1.7 christos }
1442 1.7 christos /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1443 1.7 christos sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1444 1.7 christos two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1445 1.7 christos are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1446 1.7 christos if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1447 1.7 christos {
1448 1.7 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1449 1.1 christos m->p_flags = p_flags;
1450 1.1 christos }
1451 1.7 christos if (j == m->count)
1452 1.1 christos continue;
1453 1.1 christos
1454 1.1 christos /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1455 1.1 christos the remainder are put in a new segment.
1456 1.1 christos The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1457 1.1 christos
1458 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1459 1.10 christos amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1460 1.1 christos n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1461 1.1 christos if (n == NULL)
1462 1.1 christos return false;
1463 1.1 christos
1464 1.7 christos n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1465 1.7 christos n->count = m->count - j;
1466 1.7 christos for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1467 1.1 christos n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1468 1.1 christos m->count = j;
1469 1.1 christos m->p_size_valid = 0;
1470 1.1 christos n->next = m->next;
1471 1.10 christos m->next = n;
1472 1.1 christos }
1473 1.1 christos
1474 1.1 christos return true;
1475 1.1 christos }
1476 1.1 christos
1477 1.1 christos /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1478 1.1 christos .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1479 1.1 christos that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1480 1.1 christos 2 sections. */
1481 1.6 christos
1482 1.6 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1483 1.6 christos {
1484 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1485 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1486 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1487 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1488 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1489 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1490 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1491 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1492 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1493 1.1 christos { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1494 1.10 christos };
1495 1.7 christos
1496 1.1 christos /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1497 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1498 1.7 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1499 1.1 christos
1500 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1501 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1502 1.1 christos {
1503 1.1 christos const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1504 1.1 christos
1505 1.1 christos /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1506 1.1 christos if (sec->name == NULL)
1507 1.1 christos return NULL;
1508 1.1 christos
1509 1.1 christos ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1510 1.1 christos sec->use_rela_p);
1511 1.1 christos if (ssect != NULL)
1512 1.1 christos {
1513 1.1 christos if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1514 1.1 christos ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1515 1.1 christos return ssect;
1516 1.1 christos }
1517 1.1 christos
1518 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1519 1.1 christos }
1520 1.1 christos
1521 1.1 christos /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1523 1.1 christos typedef struct apuinfo_list
1524 1.1 christos {
1525 1.1 christos struct apuinfo_list *next;
1526 1.1 christos unsigned long value;
1527 1.10 christos }
1528 1.1 christos apuinfo_list;
1529 1.1 christos
1530 1.1 christos static apuinfo_list *head;
1531 1.1 christos static bool apuinfo_set;
1532 1.1 christos
1533 1.10 christos static void
1534 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init (void)
1535 1.1 christos {
1536 1.1 christos head = NULL;
1537 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = false;
1538 1.1 christos }
1539 1.1 christos
1540 1.1 christos static void
1541 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1542 1.1 christos {
1543 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1544 1.1 christos
1545 1.1 christos while (entry != NULL)
1546 1.1 christos {
1547 1.1 christos if (entry->value == value)
1548 1.1 christos return;
1549 1.1 christos entry = entry->next;
1550 1.1 christos }
1551 1.1 christos
1552 1.1 christos entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1553 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
1554 1.1 christos return;
1555 1.1 christos
1556 1.1 christos entry->value = value;
1557 1.1 christos entry->next = head;
1558 1.1 christos head = entry;
1559 1.1 christos }
1560 1.1 christos
1561 1.1 christos static unsigned
1562 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_length (void)
1563 1.1 christos {
1564 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry;
1565 1.1 christos unsigned long count;
1566 1.1 christos
1567 1.1 christos for (entry = head, count = 0;
1568 1.1 christos entry;
1569 1.1 christos entry = entry->next)
1570 1.1 christos ++ count;
1571 1.1 christos
1572 1.1 christos return count;
1573 1.1 christos }
1574 1.1 christos
1575 1.1 christos static inline unsigned long
1576 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1577 1.1 christos {
1578 1.1 christos apuinfo_list * entry;
1579 1.1 christos
1580 1.1 christos for (entry = head;
1581 1.1 christos entry && number --;
1582 1.1 christos entry = entry->next)
1583 1.1 christos ;
1584 1.1 christos
1585 1.1 christos return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1586 1.1 christos }
1587 1.1 christos
1588 1.1 christos static void
1589 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1590 1.1 christos {
1591 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry;
1592 1.1 christos
1593 1.1 christos for (entry = head; entry;)
1594 1.1 christos {
1595 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1596 1.1 christos free (entry);
1597 1.1 christos entry = next;
1598 1.1 christos }
1599 1.1 christos
1600 1.1 christos head = NULL;
1601 1.1 christos }
1602 1.1 christos
1603 1.1 christos /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1604 1.1 christos the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1605 1.1 christos
1606 1.1 christos static void
1607 1.1 christos ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1608 1.1 christos {
1609 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
1610 1.1 christos asection *asec;
1611 1.1 christos char *buffer = NULL;
1612 1.1 christos bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1613 1.1 christos unsigned i;
1614 1.1 christos unsigned long length;
1615 1.1 christos const char *error_message = NULL;
1616 1.1 christos
1617 1.1 christos if (link_info == NULL)
1618 1.1 christos return;
1619 1.3 christos
1620 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init ();
1621 1.1 christos
1622 1.1 christos /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1623 1.1 christos for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1624 1.1 christos {
1625 1.1 christos unsigned long datum;
1626 1.1 christos
1627 1.7 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1628 1.7 christos if (asec == NULL)
1629 1.1 christos continue;
1630 1.1 christos
1631 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1632 1.1 christos error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1633 1.10 christos length = asec->size;
1634 1.1 christos if (length < 20)
1635 1.1 christos goto fail;
1636 1.10 christos
1637 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = true;
1638 1.1 christos if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1639 1.1 christos {
1640 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1641 1.1 christos largest_input_size = asec->size;
1642 1.1 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1643 1.1 christos if (!buffer)
1644 1.11 christos return;
1645 1.1 christos }
1646 1.7 christos
1647 1.7 christos if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1648 1.1 christos || (bfd_read (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1649 1.1 christos {
1650 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1651 1.1 christos error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1652 1.1 christos goto fail;
1653 1.1 christos }
1654 1.1 christos
1655 1.1 christos /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1656 1.1 christos extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1657 1.1 christos host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1658 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1659 1.1 christos if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1660 1.1 christos goto fail;
1661 1.1 christos
1662 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1663 1.1 christos if (datum != 0x2)
1664 1.1 christos goto fail;
1665 1.1 christos
1666 1.1 christos if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1667 1.1 christos goto fail;
1668 1.1 christos
1669 1.1 christos /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1670 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1671 1.1 christos if (datum + 20 != length)
1672 1.1 christos goto fail;
1673 1.1 christos
1674 1.1 christos /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1675 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1676 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1677 1.1 christos }
1678 1.1 christos
1679 1.1 christos error_message = NULL;
1680 1.1 christos
1681 1.1 christos if (apuinfo_set)
1682 1.1 christos {
1683 1.1 christos /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1684 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1685 1.9 christos
1686 1.1 christos /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1687 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1688 1.7 christos
1689 1.7 christos if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1690 1.1 christos {
1691 1.1 christos ibfd = abfd;
1692 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1693 1.1 christos error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1694 1.10 christos }
1695 1.1 christos }
1696 1.1 christos
1697 1.7 christos fail:
1698 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1699 1.1 christos
1700 1.1 christos if (error_message)
1701 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1702 1.1 christos }
1703 1.10 christos
1704 1.1 christos /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1705 1.1 christos contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1706 1.1 christos
1707 1.1 christos static bool
1708 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1709 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1710 1.1 christos asection *asec,
1711 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1712 1.1 christos {
1713 1.1 christos return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1714 1.1 christos }
1715 1.9 christos
1716 1.1 christos /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1717 1.1 christos
1718 1.1 christos static void
1719 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1720 1.1 christos {
1721 1.1 christos bfd_byte *buffer;
1722 1.1 christos asection *asec;
1723 1.1 christos unsigned i;
1724 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries;
1725 1.1 christos bfd_size_type length;
1726 1.1 christos
1727 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1728 1.1 christos if (asec == NULL)
1729 1.1 christos return;
1730 1.1 christos
1731 1.1 christos if (!apuinfo_set)
1732 1.1 christos return;
1733 1.1 christos
1734 1.1 christos length = asec->size;
1735 1.1 christos if (length < 20)
1736 1.1 christos return;
1737 1.7 christos
1738 1.7 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1739 1.1 christos if (buffer == NULL)
1740 1.1 christos {
1741 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
1742 1.1 christos (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1743 1.1 christos return;
1744 1.1 christos }
1745 1.1 christos
1746 1.1 christos /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1747 1.1 christos num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1748 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1749 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1750 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1751 1.1 christos strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1752 1.1 christos
1753 1.1 christos length = 20;
1754 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1755 1.1 christos {
1756 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1757 1.7 christos length += 4;
1758 1.1 christos }
1759 1.1 christos
1760 1.7 christos if (length != asec->size)
1761 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1762 1.1 christos
1763 1.1 christos if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1764 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1765 1.1 christos
1766 1.9 christos free (buffer);
1767 1.10 christos
1768 1.9 christos apuinfo_list_finish ();
1769 1.9 christos }
1770 1.9 christos
1771 1.9 christos static bool
1772 1.9 christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1773 1.1 christos {
1774 1.10 christos ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1775 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1776 1.1 christos }
1777 1.7 christos
1778 1.1 christos static bool
1780 1.10 christos is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1781 1.1 christos {
1782 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1783 1.1 christos
1784 1.1 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1785 1.1 christos return false;
1786 1.1 christos
1787 1.1 christos return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1788 1.10 christos && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1789 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1790 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1791 1.1 christos }
1792 1.1 christos
1793 1.1 christos static bool
1794 1.1 christos section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1795 1.1 christos {
1796 1.1 christos bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1797 1.1 christos return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1798 1.1 christos && section->vma <= vma
1799 1.1 christos && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1800 1.1 christos }
1801 1.1 christos
1802 1.10 christos static long
1803 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1804 1.1 christos long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1805 1.1 christos asymbol **ret)
1806 1.7 christos {
1807 1.1 christos bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
1808 1.1 christos asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1809 1.9 christos bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1810 1.1 christos bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1811 1.1 christos bfd_vma stub_off;
1812 1.1 christos asymbol *s;
1813 1.1 christos arelent *p;
1814 1.1 christos size_t count, i, stub_delta;
1815 1.1 christos size_t size;
1816 1.1 christos char *names;
1817 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4];
1818 1.1 christos
1819 1.1 christos *ret = NULL;
1820 1.1 christos
1821 1.1 christos if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1822 1.1 christos return 0;
1823 1.1 christos
1824 1.1 christos if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1825 1.1 christos return 0;
1826 1.1 christos
1827 1.1 christos relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1828 1.1 christos if (relplt == NULL)
1829 1.1 christos return 0;
1830 1.1 christos
1831 1.1 christos plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1832 1.1 christos if (plt == NULL)
1833 1.1 christos return 0;
1834 1.1 christos
1835 1.1 christos /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1836 1.1 christos if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1837 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1838 1.11 christos dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1839 1.11 christos
1840 1.1 christos /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1841 1.1 christos of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1842 1.1 christos dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1843 1.1 christos if (dynamic != NULL
1844 1.1 christos && (dynamic->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0)
1845 1.1 christos {
1846 1.1 christos bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1847 1.1 christos size_t extdynsize;
1848 1.1 christos void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1849 1.1 christos
1850 1.1 christos if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1851 1.11 christos return -1;
1852 1.11 christos
1853 1.11 christos extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1854 1.1 christos swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1855 1.1 christos
1856 1.1 christos for (extdyn = dynbuf, extdynend = dynbuf + dynamic->size;
1857 1.1 christos (size_t) (extdynend - extdyn) >= extdynsize;
1858 1.1 christos extdyn += extdynsize)
1859 1.1 christos {
1860 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1861 1.1 christos (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1862 1.1 christos
1863 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1864 1.1 christos break;
1865 1.1 christos
1866 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1867 1.1 christos {
1868 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1869 1.1 christos asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1870 1.1 christos if (got != NULL
1871 1.1 christos && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1872 1.1 christos g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1873 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1874 1.1 christos break;
1875 1.1 christos }
1876 1.1 christos }
1877 1.1 christos free (dynbuf);
1878 1.1 christos }
1879 1.1 christos
1880 1.1 christos /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1881 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0)
1882 1.1 christos {
1883 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1884 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1885 1.1 christos }
1886 1.1 christos
1887 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0)
1888 1.1 christos return 0;
1889 1.1 christos
1890 1.1 christos /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1891 1.1 christos link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1892 1.1 christos glink stubs now reside. */
1893 1.1 christos glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1894 1.1 christos if (glink == NULL)
1895 1.1 christos return 0;
1896 1.1 christos
1897 1.1 christos /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1898 1.1 christos from the first glink stub. */
1899 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1900 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1901 1.1 christos {
1902 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1903 1.1 christos
1904 1.1 christos /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1905 1.1 christos insn ^= B;
1906 1.1 christos if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1907 1.1 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1908 1.1 christos
1909 1.1 christos /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1910 1.1 christos else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1911 1.1 christos for (i = 4;
1912 1.1 christos bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1913 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1914 1.1 christos i += 4)
1915 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1916 1.1 christos {
1917 1.11 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1918 1.1 christos break;
1919 1.1 christos }
1920 1.1 christos }
1921 1.7 christos
1922 1.7 christos count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr);
1923 1.7 christos /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1924 1.7 christos multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1925 1.7 christos there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1926 1.7 christos of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1927 1.7 christos The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1928 1.7 christos GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1929 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1930 1.1 christos for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1931 1.1 christos if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1932 1.10 christos break;
1933 1.1 christos if (stub_delta > 32)
1934 1.1 christos return 0;
1935 1.1 christos
1936 1.1 christos slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1937 1.1 christos if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true))
1938 1.1 christos return -1;
1939 1.1 christos
1940 1.1 christos size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1941 1.1 christos p = relplt->relocation;
1942 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1943 1.1 christos {
1944 1.1 christos size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1945 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0)
1946 1.1 christos size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1947 1.1 christos }
1948 1.1 christos
1949 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1950 1.1 christos
1951 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma)
1952 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1953 1.7 christos
1954 1.1 christos s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1955 1.3 christos if (s == NULL)
1956 1.3 christos return -1;
1957 1.1 christos
1958 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1959 1.1 christos names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1960 1.7 christos p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1961 1.7 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1962 1.7 christos {
1963 1.1 christos size_t len;
1964 1.1 christos
1965 1.1 christos stub_off -= stub_delta;
1966 1.1 christos if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1967 1.1 christos stub_off -= 32;
1968 1.1 christos *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1969 1.1 christos /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1970 1.7 christos we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1971 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1972 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1973 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1974 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
1975 1.1 christos s->value = stub_off;
1976 1.1 christos s->name = names;
1977 1.1 christos s->udata.p = NULL;
1978 1.1 christos len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1979 1.1 christos memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1980 1.1 christos names += len;
1981 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0)
1982 1.1 christos {
1983 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1984 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1985 1.1 christos bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1986 1.3 christos names += strlen (names);
1987 1.1 christos }
1988 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1989 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("@plt");
1990 1.1 christos ++s;
1991 1.1 christos --p;
1992 1.1 christos }
1993 1.1 christos
1994 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1995 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1996 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd;
1997 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1998 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
1999 1.1 christos s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
2000 1.1 christos s->name = names;
2001 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
2002 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink");
2003 1.1 christos s++;
2004 1.1 christos count++;
2005 1.1 christos
2006 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma)
2007 1.1 christos {
2008 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
2009 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2010 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd;
2011 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2012 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
2013 1.1 christos s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2014 1.1 christos s->name = names;
2015 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2016 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2017 1.1 christos s++;
2018 1.1 christos count++;
2019 1.1 christos }
2020 1.1 christos
2021 1.1 christos return count;
2022 1.1 christos }
2023 1.1 christos
2024 1.1 christos /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2026 1.1 christos functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2027 1.1 christos or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2028 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2029 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2030 1.1 christos called. */
2031 1.1 christos
2032 1.1 christos /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2033 1.1 christos than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2034 1.1 christos struct plt_entry
2035 1.1 christos {
2036 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *next;
2037 1.1 christos
2038 1.1 christos /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2039 1.1 christos This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2040 1.1 christos GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2041 1.1 christos gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2042 1.1 christos sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2043 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
2044 1.1 christos
2045 1.1 christos /* The .got2 section. */
2046 1.1 christos asection *sec;
2047 1.1 christos
2048 1.1 christos /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2049 1.1 christos union
2050 1.1 christos {
2051 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2052 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
2053 1.7 christos } plt;
2054 1.7 christos
2055 1.7 christos /* .glink stub offset. */
2056 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_offset;
2057 1.1 christos };
2058 1.1 christos
2059 1.1 christos /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2060 1.1 christos function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2061 1.1 christos library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2062 1.1 christos
2063 1.1 christos static int
2064 1.7 christos must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2065 1.7 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2066 1.7 christos {
2067 1.7 christos switch (r_type)
2068 1.1 christos {
2069 1.1 christos default:
2070 1.1 christos /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2071 1.1 christos address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2072 1.1 christos dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2073 1.1 christos local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2074 1.1 christos return 1;
2075 1.1 christos
2076 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
2077 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
2078 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2079 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2080 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
2081 1.1 christos return 0;
2082 1.7 christos
2083 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2084 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2085 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2086 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2087 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2088 1.1 christos /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2089 1.1 christos linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2090 1.1 christos return bfd_link_dll (info);
2091 1.1 christos }
2092 1.1 christos }
2093 1.1 christos
2094 1.3 christos /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2095 1.3 christos copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2096 1.3 christos section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2097 1.3 christos shared lib. */
2098 1.3 christos #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2099 1.3 christos
2100 1.3 christos /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2101 1.3 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2102 1.3 christos {
2103 1.3 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2104 1.3 christos
2105 1.3 christos /* The input section of the reloc. */
2106 1.3 christos asection *sec;
2107 1.3 christos
2108 1.3 christos /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2109 1.1 christos unsigned int count : 31;
2110 1.1 christos
2111 1.1 christos /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2112 1.1 christos unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2113 1.1 christos };
2114 1.1 christos
2115 1.1 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2116 1.1 christos
2117 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2118 1.1 christos {
2119 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2120 1.7 christos
2121 1.7 christos /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2122 1.7 christos specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2123 1.7 christos from the beginning of the section. */
2124 1.7 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2125 1.7 christos
2126 1.9 christos /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2127 1.7 christos Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2128 1.7 christos encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2129 1.7 christos of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2130 1.7 christos optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2131 1.7 christos needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2132 1.7 christos set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2133 1.7 christos These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2134 1.9 christos #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2135 1.7 christos #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2136 1.7 christos #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2137 1.7 christos #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2138 1.7 christos #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2139 1.7 christos #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2140 1.7 christos #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2141 1.7 christos unsigned char tls_mask;
2142 1.1 christos
2143 1.1 christos /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2144 1.1 christos case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2145 1.3 christos #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2146 1.3 christos #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2147 1.3 christos #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2148 1.3 christos
2149 1.3 christos /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2150 1.1 christos symbol. */
2151 1.1 christos unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2152 1.1 christos
2153 1.1 christos /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2154 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2155 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2156 1.1 christos };
2157 1.1 christos
2158 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2159 1.1 christos
2160 1.3 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2161 1.3 christos
2162 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2163 1.1 christos {
2164 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2165 1.1 christos
2166 1.1 christos /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2167 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2168 1.1 christos
2169 1.1 christos /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2170 1.7 christos asection *glink;
2171 1.7 christos asection *dynsbss;
2172 1.1 christos asection *relsbss;
2173 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2174 1.1 christos asection *sbss;
2175 1.1 christos asection *glink_eh_frame;
2176 1.1 christos asection *pltlocal;
2177 1.1 christos asection *relpltlocal;
2178 1.1 christos
2179 1.1 christos /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2180 1.1 christos asection *srelplt2;
2181 1.1 christos
2182 1.1 christos /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2183 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2184 1.1 christos
2185 1.1 christos /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2186 1.1 christos bfd *old_bfd;
2187 1.1 christos
2188 1.1 christos /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2189 1.1 christos union {
2190 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2191 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
2192 1.1 christos } tlsld_got;
2193 1.1 christos
2194 1.1 christos /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2195 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2196 1.1 christos
2197 1.1 christos /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2198 1.1 christos unsigned int got_header_size;
2199 1.7 christos /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2200 1.7 christos unsigned int got_gap;
2201 1.7 christos
2202 1.7 christos /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2203 1.7 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2204 1.7 christos
2205 1.7 christos /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2206 1.7 christos referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2207 1.7 christos unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2208 1.7 christos unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2209 1.7 christos
2210 1.1 christos /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2211 1.1 christos unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2212 1.1 christos
2213 1.1 christos /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2214 1.1 christos unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2215 1.1 christos
2216 1.1 christos /* The size of PLT entries. */
2217 1.1 christos int plt_entry_size;
2218 1.1 christos /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2219 1.1 christos int plt_slot_size;
2220 1.1 christos /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2221 1.1 christos int plt_initial_entry_size;
2222 1.1 christos };
2223 1.1 christos
2224 1.9 christos /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2225 1.9 christos are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2226 1.9 christos
2227 1.1 christos /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2228 1.7 christos #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2229 1.7 christos
2230 1.7 christos /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2231 1.1 christos relocs. */
2232 1.1 christos #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2233 1.1 christos
2234 1.10 christos /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2235 1.10 christos #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2236 1.10 christos
2237 1.1 christos /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2238 1.1 christos
2239 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2240 1.1 christos ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash) \
2241 1.1 christos && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA) \
2242 1.1 christos ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
2243 1.1 christos
2244 1.1 christos /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2245 1.1 christos
2246 1.1 christos static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2247 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2248 1.1 christos struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2249 1.1 christos const char *string)
2250 1.1 christos {
2251 1.1 christos /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2252 1.1 christos subclass. */
2253 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
2254 1.1 christos {
2255 1.1 christos entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2256 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2257 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
2258 1.1 christos return entry;
2259 1.1 christos }
2260 1.1 christos
2261 1.1 christos /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2262 1.1 christos entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2263 1.1 christos if (entry != NULL)
2264 1.1 christos {
2265 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2266 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2267 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2268 1.1 christos }
2269 1.1 christos
2270 1.1 christos return entry;
2271 1.1 christos }
2272 1.1 christos
2273 1.7 christos /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2274 1.7 christos
2275 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2276 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2277 1.1 christos {
2278 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2279 1.1 christos static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2280 1.1 christos = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2281 1.1 christos
2282 1.1 christos ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2283 1.1 christos if (ret == NULL)
2284 1.1 christos return NULL;
2285 1.1 christos
2286 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2287 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2288 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2289 1.1 christos PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2290 1.1 christos {
2291 1.1 christos free (ret);
2292 1.1 christos return NULL;
2293 1.1 christos }
2294 1.3 christos
2295 1.3 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2296 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2297 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2298 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2299 1.1 christos
2300 1.1 christos ret->params = &default_params;
2301 1.1 christos
2302 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2303 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2304 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2305 1.1 christos
2306 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2307 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2308 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2309 1.1 christos
2310 1.1 christos ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2311 1.3 christos ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2312 1.3 christos ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2313 1.3 christos
2314 1.3 christos return &ret->elf.root;
2315 1.3 christos }
2316 1.3 christos
2317 1.3 christos /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2318 1.3 christos
2319 1.3 christos void
2320 1.7 christos ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2321 1.3 christos {
2322 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2323 1.1 christos
2324 1.1 christos if (htab)
2325 1.10 christos htab->params = params;
2326 1.1 christos params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2327 1.1 christos }
2328 1.1 christos
2329 1.1 christos /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2330 1.1 christos
2331 1.10 christos static bool
2332 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2333 1.1 christos {
2334 1.10 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2335 1.1 christos
2336 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2337 1.1 christos return false;
2338 1.7 christos
2339 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2340 1.9 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2341 1.10 christos {
2342 1.1 christos /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2343 1.1 christos executable. */
2344 1.10 christos flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2345 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2346 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2347 1.3 christos return false;
2348 1.3 christos }
2349 1.3 christos
2350 1.3 christos return true;
2351 1.10 christos }
2352 1.3 christos
2353 1.3 christos /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2354 1.3 christos R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2355 1.3 christos and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2356 1.3 christos
2357 1.3 christos static bool
2358 1.3 christos ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2359 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2360 1.3 christos flagword flags,
2361 1.3 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2362 1.3 christos {
2363 1.3 christos asection *s;
2364 1.10 christos
2365 1.3 christos flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2366 1.3 christos | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2367 1.3 christos
2368 1.3 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2369 1.3 christos if (s == NULL)
2370 1.3 christos return false;
2371 1.3 christos lsect->section = s;
2372 1.10 christos
2373 1.3 christos /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2374 1.10 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2375 1.3 christos
2376 1.3 christos lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2377 1.10 christos if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2378 1.1 christos return false;
2379 1.1 christos lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2380 1.1 christos return true;
2381 1.1 christos }
2382 1.1 christos
2383 1.7 christos static bool
2384 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2385 1.1 christos {
2386 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2387 1.1 christos asection *s;
2388 1.1 christos flagword flags;
2389 1.7 christos int p2align;
2390 1.7 christos
2391 1.7 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2392 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2393 1.9 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2394 1.10 christos htab->glink = s;
2395 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2396 1.1 christos if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2397 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2398 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2399 1.1 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2400 1.1 christos return false;
2401 1.1 christos
2402 1.1 christos if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2403 1.9 christos {
2404 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2405 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2406 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2407 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2408 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2409 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2410 1.1 christos return false;
2411 1.9 christos }
2412 1.10 christos
2413 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2414 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2415 1.1 christos htab->elf.iplt = s;
2416 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2417 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2418 1.1 christos return false;
2419 1.9 christos
2420 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2421 1.3 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2422 1.7 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2423 1.7 christos htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2424 1.7 christos if (s == NULL
2425 1.7 christos || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2426 1.7 christos return false;
2427 1.7 christos
2428 1.9 christos /* Local plt entries. */
2429 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2430 1.7 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2431 1.7 christos htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2432 1.7 christos flags);
2433 1.7 christos if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2434 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2435 1.7 christos return false;
2436 1.7 christos
2437 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2438 1.9 christos {
2439 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2440 1.7 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2441 1.7 christos htab->relpltlocal
2442 1.3 christos = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2443 1.3 christos if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2444 1.10 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2445 1.3 christos return false;
2446 1.3 christos }
2447 1.3 christos
2448 1.10 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2449 1.3 christos &htab->sdata[0]))
2450 1.10 christos return false;
2451 1.1 christos
2452 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2453 1.1 christos &htab->sdata[1]))
2454 1.1 christos return false;
2455 1.1 christos
2456 1.1 christos return true;
2457 1.10 christos }
2458 1.1 christos
2459 1.1 christos /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2460 1.1 christos to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2461 1.1 christos to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2462 1.1 christos
2463 1.1 christos static bool
2464 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2465 1.1 christos {
2466 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2467 1.1 christos asection *s;
2468 1.10 christos flagword flags;
2469 1.1 christos
2470 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2471 1.10 christos
2472 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2473 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2474 1.1 christos return false;
2475 1.10 christos
2476 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2477 1.1 christos return false;
2478 1.1 christos
2479 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL
2480 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2481 1.10 christos return false;
2482 1.1 christos
2483 1.3 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2484 1.1 christos SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2485 1.1 christos htab->dynsbss = s;
2486 1.1 christos if (s == NULL)
2487 1.1 christos return false;
2488 1.1 christos
2489 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2490 1.9 christos {
2491 1.10 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2492 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2493 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2494 1.10 christos htab->relsbss = s;
2495 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2496 1.10 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2497 1.1 christos return false;
2498 1.7 christos }
2499 1.1 christos
2500 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
2501 1.1 christos && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2502 1.1 christos return false;
2503 1.9 christos
2504 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
2505 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2506 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2507 1.1 christos /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2508 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2509 1.1 christos return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2510 1.1 christos }
2511 1.1 christos
2512 1.1 christos /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2513 1.1 christos
2514 1.1 christos static void
2515 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2516 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2517 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2518 1.1 christos {
2519 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2520 1.1 christos
2521 1.7 christos edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2522 1.7 christos eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2523 1.1 christos
2524 1.1 christos edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2525 1.7 christos edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2526 1.1 christos
2527 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2528 1.1 christos edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2529 1.7 christos edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2530 1.7 christos edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2531 1.7 christos edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2532 1.7 christos edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2533 1.10 christos edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2534 1.1 christos
2535 1.10 christos /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2536 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2537 1.1 christos return;
2538 1.1 christos
2539 1.1 christos if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2540 1.1 christos {
2541 1.1 christos if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2542 1.10 christos {
2543 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2544 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2545 1.1 christos
2546 1.10 christos /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2547 1.1 christos list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2548 1.1 christos for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2549 1.1 christos {
2550 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2551 1.1 christos
2552 1.1 christos for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2553 1.1 christos if (q->sec == p->sec)
2554 1.1 christos {
2555 1.1 christos q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2556 1.1 christos q->count += p->count;
2557 1.10 christos *pp = p->next;
2558 1.1 christos break;
2559 1.1 christos }
2560 1.10 christos if (q == NULL)
2561 1.10 christos pp = &p->next;
2562 1.1 christos }
2563 1.1 christos *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
2564 1.1 christos }
2565 1.1 christos
2566 1.1 christos dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
2567 1.1 christos ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2568 1.1 christos }
2569 1.1 christos
2570 1.1 christos /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2571 1.1 christos the symbol which just became indirect. */
2572 1.1 christos edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2573 1.1 christos eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2574 1.1 christos
2575 1.1 christos /* And plt entries. */
2576 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2577 1.1 christos {
2578 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2579 1.1 christos {
2580 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **entp;
2581 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2582 1.1 christos
2583 1.1 christos for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2584 1.1 christos {
2585 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *dent;
2586 1.1 christos
2587 1.1 christos for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2588 1.1 christos if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2589 1.1 christos {
2590 1.1 christos dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2591 1.1 christos *entp = ent->next;
2592 1.1 christos break;
2593 1.1 christos }
2594 1.1 christos if (dent == NULL)
2595 1.1 christos entp = &ent->next;
2596 1.1 christos }
2597 1.1 christos *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2598 1.1 christos }
2599 1.1 christos
2600 1.1 christos edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2601 1.1 christos eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2602 1.1 christos }
2603 1.1 christos
2604 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2605 1.1 christos {
2606 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2607 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2608 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2609 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2610 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2611 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2612 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2613 1.10 christos }
2614 1.1 christos }
2615 1.1 christos
2616 1.1 christos /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2617 1.1 christos file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2618 1.1 christos
2619 1.1 christos static bool
2620 1.1 christos ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2621 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2622 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2623 1.3 christos const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2624 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2625 1.1 christos asection **secp,
2626 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp)
2627 1.1 christos {
2628 1.1 christos if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2629 1.1 christos && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2630 1.1 christos && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2631 1.1 christos && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2632 1.1 christos {
2633 1.1 christos /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2634 1.10 christos put into .sbss. */
2635 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2636 1.1 christos
2637 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2638 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2639 1.1 christos {
2640 1.1 christos flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2641 1.1 christos
2642 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2643 1.10 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2644 1.1 christos
2645 1.1 christos htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2646 1.1 christos ".sbss",
2647 1.1 christos flags);
2648 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2649 1.1 christos return false;
2650 1.10 christos }
2651 1.1 christos
2652 1.1 christos *secp = htab->sbss;
2653 1.1 christos *valp = sym->st_size;
2654 1.1 christos }
2655 1.1 christos
2656 1.1 christos return true;
2657 1.1 christos }
2658 1.1 christos
2659 1.1 christos /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2661 1.1 christos
2662 1.1 christos static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2663 1.1 christos elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2664 1.1 christos (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2665 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend,
2666 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2667 1.1 christos {
2668 1.1 christos for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2669 1.1 christos if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2670 1.10 christos return linker_pointers;
2671 1.3 christos
2672 1.3 christos return NULL;
2673 1.3 christos }
2674 1.3 christos
2675 1.1 christos /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2676 1.1 christos
2677 1.1 christos static bool
2678 1.1 christos elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2679 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2680 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2681 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2682 1.1 christos {
2683 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2684 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2685 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2686 1.1 christos bfd_size_type amt;
2687 1.1 christos
2688 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2689 1.1 christos
2690 1.1 christos /* Is this a global symbol? */
2691 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
2692 1.1 christos {
2693 1.10 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2694 1.1 christos
2695 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2696 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2697 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2698 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
2699 1.1 christos lsect))
2700 1.1 christos return true;
2701 1.1 christos
2702 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2703 1.1 christos }
2704 1.1 christos else
2705 1.1 christos {
2706 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2707 1.1 christos
2708 1.1 christos /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2709 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2710 1.1 christos
2711 1.1 christos /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2712 1.1 christos if (!ptr)
2713 1.1 christos {
2714 1.10 christos unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2715 1.1 christos
2716 1.1 christos amt = num_symbols;
2717 1.1 christos amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2718 1.1 christos ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2719 1.1 christos
2720 1.1 christos if (!ptr)
2721 1.1 christos return false;
2722 1.1 christos
2723 1.10 christos elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2724 1.1 christos }
2725 1.1 christos
2726 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2727 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2728 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
2729 1.1 christos lsect))
2730 1.1 christos return true;
2731 1.1 christos
2732 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2733 1.1 christos }
2734 1.1 christos
2735 1.10 christos /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2736 1.1 christos a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2737 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2738 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2739 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2740 1.1 christos
2741 1.1 christos if (!linker_section_ptr)
2742 1.9 christos return false;
2743 1.10 christos
2744 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2745 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2746 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2747 1.1 christos *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2748 1.1 christos
2749 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2750 1.1 christos return false;
2751 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2752 1.1 christos lsect->section->size += 4;
2753 1.1 christos
2754 1.10 christos #ifdef DEBUG
2755 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
2756 1.1 christos "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2757 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2758 1.1 christos (long) lsect->section->size);
2759 1.1 christos #endif
2760 1.1 christos
2761 1.1 christos return true;
2762 1.1 christos }
2763 1.1 christos
2764 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry **
2765 1.7 christos update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2766 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2767 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx,
2768 1.1 christos int tls_type)
2769 1.1 christos {
2770 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2771 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2772 1.1 christos unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2773 1.1 christos
2774 1.1 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2775 1.1 christos {
2776 1.1 christos bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2777 1.1 christos
2778 1.1 christos size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2779 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_plt)
2780 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2781 1.7 christos local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2782 1.7 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2783 1.7 christos return NULL;
2784 1.1 christos elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2785 1.1 christos }
2786 1.1 christos
2787 1.1 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2788 1.10 christos local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2789 1.1 christos local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2790 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2791 1.1 christos local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2792 1.1 christos return local_plt + r_symndx;
2793 1.1 christos }
2794 1.1 christos
2795 1.1 christos static bool
2796 1.1 christos update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2797 1.1 christos asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2798 1.1 christos {
2799 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2800 1.1 christos
2801 1.10 christos if (addend < 32768)
2802 1.1 christos sec = NULL;
2803 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2804 1.10 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2805 1.1 christos break;
2806 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL)
2807 1.1 christos {
2808 1.1 christos size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
2809 1.1 christos ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2810 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL)
2811 1.1 christos return false;
2812 1.10 christos ent->next = *plist;
2813 1.1 christos ent->sec = sec;
2814 1.1 christos ent->addend = addend;
2815 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2816 1.1 christos *plist = ent;
2817 1.1 christos }
2818 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2819 1.1 christos return true;
2820 1.1 christos }
2821 1.1 christos
2822 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry *
2823 1.1 christos find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2824 1.1 christos {
2825 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2826 1.1 christos
2827 1.1 christos if (addend < 32768)
2828 1.10 christos sec = NULL;
2829 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2830 1.1 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2831 1.1 christos break;
2832 1.1 christos return ent;
2833 1.1 christos }
2834 1.1 christos
2835 1.1 christos static bool
2836 1.1 christos is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2837 1.1 christos {
2838 1.1 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2839 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2840 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2841 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2842 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2843 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2844 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2845 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2846 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2847 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2848 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2849 1.7 christos }
2850 1.7 christos
2851 1.7 christos /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2852 1.7 christos
2853 1.1 christos static bool
2854 1.1 christos is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2855 1.10 christos {
2856 1.10 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2857 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2858 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2859 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2860 1.10 christos }
2861 1.10 christos
2862 1.10 christos /* Like bfd_reloc_offset_in_range but without a howto. Return true
2863 1.10 christos iff a field of SIZE bytes at OFFSET is within SEC limits. */
2864 1.1 christos
2865 1.1 christos static bool
2866 1.1 christos offset_in_range (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, size_t size)
2867 1.7 christos {
2868 1.7 christos return offset <= sec->size && size <= sec->size - offset;
2869 1.7 christos }
2870 1.1 christos
2871 1.1 christos static void
2872 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2873 1.1 christos {
2874 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
2875 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2876 1.1 christos (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2877 1.1 christos abfd,
2878 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2879 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2880 1.1 christos }
2881 1.1 christos
2882 1.1 christos /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2883 1.1 christos allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2884 1.1 christos table. */
2885 1.1 christos
2886 1.1 christos static bool
2887 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2888 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2889 1.1 christos asection *sec,
2890 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2891 1.1 christos {
2892 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2893 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2894 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2895 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2896 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2897 1.7 christos asection *got2, *sreloc;
2898 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2899 1.1 christos
2900 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2901 1.1 christos return true;
2902 1.1 christos
2903 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
2904 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2905 1.1 christos sec, abfd);
2906 1.1 christos #endif
2907 1.1 christos
2908 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2909 1.1 christos
2910 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2911 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2912 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2913 1.10 christos
2914 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2915 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL)
2916 1.10 christos {
2917 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2918 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2919 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2920 1.1 christos return false;
2921 1.1 christos }
2922 1.1 christos tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2923 1.1 christos false, false, true);
2924 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2925 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2926 1.1 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2927 1.1 christos sreloc = NULL;
2928 1.10 christos
2929 1.1 christos rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2930 1.3 christos for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2931 1.7 christos {
2932 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
2933 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2934 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2935 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
2936 1.10 christos int tls_type;
2937 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2938 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **pltent;
2939 1.10 christos bfd_vma addend;
2940 1.10 christos
2941 1.10 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2942 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2943 1.1 christos {
2944 1.1 christos h = NULL;
2945 1.1 christos isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache, abfd, r_symndx);
2946 1.1 christos if (isym == NULL)
2947 1.1 christos return false;
2948 1.10 christos }
2949 1.1 christos else
2950 1.1 christos {
2951 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2952 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2953 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2954 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2955 1.7 christos isym = NULL;
2956 1.1 christos }
2957 1.1 christos
2958 1.1 christos /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2959 1.1 christos This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2960 1.1 christos startup code. */
2961 1.10 christos if (h != NULL
2962 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2963 1.1 christos && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2964 1.1 christos {
2965 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2966 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2967 1.3 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2968 1.10 christos return false;
2969 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2970 1.10 christos }
2971 1.10 christos
2972 1.10 christos tls_type = 0;
2973 1.10 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2974 1.10 christos ifunc = NULL;
2975 1.10 christos if (h != NULL)
2976 1.10 christos {
2977 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2978 1.3 christos {
2979 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
2980 1.3 christos ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
2981 1.1 christos }
2982 1.7 christos }
2983 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2984 1.10 christos {
2985 1.1 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2986 1.1 christos {
2987 1.1 christos /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2988 1.1 christos ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2989 1.3 christos NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2990 1.7 christos if (ifunc == NULL)
2991 1.7 christos return false;
2992 1.7 christos
2993 1.7 christos /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2994 1.1 christos In a non-pie executable even when there are
2995 1.7 christos no plt calls. */
2996 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2997 1.7 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2998 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2999 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3000 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
3001 1.7 christos {
3002 1.7 christos addend = 0;
3003 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3004 1.3 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3005 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3006 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3007 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3008 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3009 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3010 1.10 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
3011 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
3012 1.1 christos return false;
3013 1.1 christos }
3014 1.1 christos }
3015 1.1 christos }
3016 1.1 christos
3017 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
3018 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3019 1.1 christos && h != NULL
3020 1.1 christos && h == tga)
3021 1.1 christos {
3022 1.1 christos if (rel != relocs
3023 1.9 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3024 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3025 1.1 christos /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3026 1.10 christos reloc. */
3027 1.1 christos ;
3028 1.1 christos else
3029 1.1 christos /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3030 1.1 christos sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3031 1.1 christos }
3032 1.7 christos
3033 1.7 christos switch (r_type)
3034 1.7 christos {
3035 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3036 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3037 1.10 christos /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3038 1.7 christos its parameter symbol. */
3039 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
3040 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3041 1.1 christos else
3042 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3043 1.1 christos NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3044 1.1 christos return false;
3045 1.1 christos break;
3046 1.1 christos
3047 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3048 1.1 christos break;
3049 1.1 christos
3050 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3051 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3052 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3053 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3054 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3055 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3056 1.1 christos
3057 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3058 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3059 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3060 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3061 1.7 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3062 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3063 1.1 christos
3064 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3065 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3066 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3067 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3068 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3069 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3070 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3071 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3072 1.1 christos
3073 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3074 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3075 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3076 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3077 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3078 1.1 christos dogottls:
3079 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3080 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3081 1.7 christos
3082 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations */
3083 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
3084 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3085 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3086 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3087 1.1 christos /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3088 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3089 1.1 christos {
3090 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3091 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3092 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3093 1.1 christos return false;
3094 1.1 christos }
3095 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3096 1.10 christos {
3097 1.1 christos h->got.refcount += 1;
3098 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3099 1.1 christos }
3100 1.3 christos else
3101 1.1 christos /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3102 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3103 1.10 christos return false;
3104 1.1 christos
3105 1.1 christos /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3106 1.1 christos an ifunc. */
3107 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3108 1.1 christos {
3109 1.3 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3110 1.3 christos return false;
3111 1.3 christos }
3112 1.10 christos break;
3113 1.1 christos
3114 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3115 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3116 1.10 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3117 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3118 1.1 christos h, rel))
3119 1.1 christos return false;
3120 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3121 1.1 christos {
3122 1.9 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3123 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3124 1.1 christos }
3125 1.10 christos break;
3126 1.1 christos
3127 1.3 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3128 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3129 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3130 1.10 christos {
3131 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3132 1.1 christos return false;
3133 1.10 christos }
3134 1.10 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3135 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3136 1.1 christos h, rel))
3137 1.1 christos return false;
3138 1.3 christos if (h != NULL)
3139 1.3 christos {
3140 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3141 1.3 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3142 1.1 christos }
3143 1.1 christos break;
3144 1.1 christos
3145 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3146 1.1 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3147 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3148 1.1 christos
3149 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3150 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3151 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3152 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3153 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3154 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3155 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3156 1.1 christos {
3157 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3158 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3159 1.1 christos }
3160 1.1 christos break;
3161 1.1 christos
3162 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3163 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3164 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3165 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3166 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3167 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3168 1.9 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3169 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3170 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3171 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3172 1.1 christos break;
3173 1.3 christos
3174 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3175 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3176 1.10 christos {
3177 1.10 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3178 1.1 christos return false;
3179 1.1 christos }
3180 1.1 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3181 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3182 1.1 christos {
3183 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3184 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3185 1.1 christos }
3186 1.1 christos break;
3187 1.10 christos
3188 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3189 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3190 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3191 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3192 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3193 1.1 christos {
3194 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3195 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3196 1.1 christos }
3197 1.1 christos break;
3198 1.10 christos
3199 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3200 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3201 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3202 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3203 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3204 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
3205 1.7 christos h->non_got_ref = true;
3206 1.7 christos break;
3207 1.7 christos
3208 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3209 1.7 christos if (h == NULL)
3210 1.7 christos break;
3211 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3212 1.1 christos goto pltentry;
3213 1.1 christos
3214 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3215 1.1 christos sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3216 1.7 christos /* Fall through. */
3217 1.1 christos
3218 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32:
3219 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3220 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3221 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3222 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3223 1.7 christos pltentry:
3224 1.7 christos #ifdef DEBUG
3225 1.7 christos fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3226 1.10 christos #endif
3227 1.7 christos /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3228 1.7 christos if (h == NULL)
3229 1.1 christos {
3230 1.7 christos pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3231 1.7 christos NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3232 1.1 christos if (pltent == NULL)
3233 1.7 christos return false;
3234 1.1 christos }
3235 1.7 christos else
3236 1.7 christos {
3237 1.7 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3238 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3239 1.7 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3240 1.7 christos pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3241 1.7 christos }
3242 1.7 christos addend = 0;
3243 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3244 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3245 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3246 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3247 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3248 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
3249 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3250 1.1 christos return false;
3251 1.1 christos break;
3252 1.1 christos
3253 1.1 christos /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3254 1.1 christos relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3255 1.1 christos section relative. */
3256 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3257 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3258 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3259 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3260 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3261 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3262 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3263 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3264 1.3 christos case R_PPC_TOC16:
3265 1.1 christos break;
3266 1.1 christos
3267 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
3268 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3269 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3270 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3271 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3272 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3273 1.1 christos break;
3274 1.1 christos
3275 1.1 christos /* These are just markers. */
3276 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
3277 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3278 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE:
3279 1.1 christos case R_PPC_max:
3280 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX:
3281 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3282 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3283 1.1 christos case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3284 1.1 christos break;
3285 1.1 christos
3286 1.1 christos /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3287 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
3288 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3289 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3290 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3291 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3292 1.1 christos break;
3293 1.1 christos
3294 1.1 christos /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3295 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3296 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3297 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3298 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3299 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3300 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3301 1.1 christos break;
3302 1.1 christos
3303 1.10 christos /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3304 1.10 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3305 1.10 christos if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3306 1.10 christos {
3307 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3308 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3309 1.1 christos }
3310 1.1 christos if (h != NULL
3311 1.1 christos && ifunc != NULL
3312 1.1 christos && !update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, NULL, 0))
3313 1.10 christos return false;
3314 1.1 christos break;
3315 1.1 christos
3316 1.1 christos /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3317 1.1 christos Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3318 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3319 1.9 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3320 1.10 christos return false;
3321 1.1 christos break;
3322 1.1 christos
3323 1.10 christos /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3324 1.10 christos used. Record for later use during GC. */
3325 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3326 1.10 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3327 1.7 christos return false;
3328 1.1 christos break;
3329 1.1 christos
3330 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3331 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3332 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3333 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3334 1.1 christos /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3335 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3336 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3337 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3338 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3339 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3340 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3341 1.1 christos
3342 1.1 christos /* Nor these. */
3343 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3344 1.3 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3345 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3346 1.1 christos
3347 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
3348 1.1 christos if (h == NULL
3349 1.1 christos && got2 != NULL
3350 1.1 christos && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3351 1.1 christos && bfd_link_pic (info)
3352 1.1 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3353 1.1 christos {
3354 1.1 christos /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3355 1.1 christos the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3356 1.1 christos reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3357 1.1 christos force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3358 1.1 christos reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3359 1.1 christos PLT call stubs. */
3360 1.1 christos asection *s;
3361 1.1 christos
3362 1.1 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3363 1.1 christos if (s == got2)
3364 1.1 christos {
3365 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3366 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3367 1.1 christos }
3368 1.1 christos }
3369 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3370 1.1 christos break;
3371 1.1 christos /* fall through */
3372 1.1 christos
3373 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3374 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3375 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3376 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3377 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3378 1.10 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3379 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3380 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3381 1.1 christos {
3382 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3383 1.3 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3384 1.3 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3385 1.3 christos return false;
3386 1.3 christos
3387 1.1 christos /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3388 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = 1;
3389 1.1 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3390 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3391 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3392 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3393 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3394 1.1 christos }
3395 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3396 1.1 christos
3397 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
3398 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
3399 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3400 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3401 1.1 christos if (h == NULL)
3402 1.1 christos break;
3403 1.1 christos if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3404 1.1 christos {
3405 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3406 1.1 christos {
3407 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3408 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3409 1.1 christos }
3410 1.1 christos break;
3411 1.3 christos }
3412 1.1 christos /* fall through */
3413 1.1 christos
3414 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3415 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3416 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3417 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3418 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3419 1.1 christos {
3420 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3421 1.1 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3422 1.10 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3423 1.10 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3424 1.10 christos return false;
3425 1.10 christos break;
3426 1.10 christos }
3427 1.10 christos
3428 1.10 christos dodyn:
3429 1.10 christos /* Set up information for symbols that might need dynamic
3430 1.10 christos relocations. At this point in linking we have read all
3431 1.10 christos the input files and resolved most symbols, but have not
3432 1.10 christos yet decided whether symbols are dynamic or finalized
3433 1.10 christos symbol flags. In some cases we might be setting dynamic
3434 1.10 christos reloc info for symbols that do not end up needing such.
3435 1.10 christos That's OK, adjust_dynamic_symbol and allocate_dynrelocs
3436 1.10 christos work together with this code. */
3437 1.1 christos if ((h != NULL
3438 1.1 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
3439 1.1 christos || (bfd_link_pic (info)
3440 1.1 christos && (h != NULL
3441 1.1 christos ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
3442 1.1 christos : isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
3443 1.1 christos && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
3444 1.1 christos {
3445 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
3446 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
3447 1.1 christos "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3448 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n",
3449 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string
3450 1.1 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3451 1.10 christos #endif
3452 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
3453 1.1 christos {
3454 1.10 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3455 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3456 1.1 christos
3457 1.1 christos sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3458 1.1 christos (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ true);
3459 1.1 christos
3460 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
3461 1.3 christos return false;
3462 1.3 christos }
3463 1.3 christos
3464 1.10 christos /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3465 1.3 christos relocations we need for this symbol. */
3466 1.3 christos if (h != NULL)
3467 1.3 christos {
3468 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3469 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3470 1.10 christos
3471 1.3 christos rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
3472 1.3 christos p = *rel_head;
3473 1.3 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3474 1.3 christos {
3475 1.3 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3476 1.3 christos if (p == NULL)
3477 1.3 christos return false;
3478 1.3 christos p->next = *rel_head;
3479 1.3 christos *rel_head = p;
3480 1.1 christos p->sec = sec;
3481 1.1 christos p->count = 0;
3482 1.1 christos p->pc_count = 0;
3483 1.1 christos }
3484 1.1 christos p->count += 1;
3485 1.1 christos if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3486 1.3 christos p->pc_count += 1;
3487 1.3 christos }
3488 1.10 christos else
3489 1.1 christos {
3490 1.1 christos /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3491 1.1 christos We really need local syms available to do this
3492 1.1 christos easily. Oh well. */
3493 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3494 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3495 1.1 christos bool is_ifunc;
3496 1.1 christos asection *s;
3497 1.3 christos void *vpp;
3498 1.10 christos
3499 1.3 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3500 1.3 christos if (s == NULL)
3501 1.3 christos s = sec;
3502 1.3 christos
3503 1.3 christos vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3504 1.3 christos rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3505 1.3 christos is_ifunc = ifunc != NULL;
3506 1.10 christos p = *rel_head;
3507 1.3 christos if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3508 1.3 christos p = p->next;
3509 1.3 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3510 1.3 christos {
3511 1.3 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3512 1.3 christos if (p == NULL)
3513 1.3 christos return false;
3514 1.1 christos p->next = *rel_head;
3515 1.1 christos *rel_head = p;
3516 1.1 christos p->sec = sec;
3517 1.1 christos p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3518 1.1 christos p->count = 0;
3519 1.1 christos }
3520 1.1 christos p->count += 1;
3521 1.10 christos }
3522 1.1 christos }
3523 1.1 christos
3524 1.7 christos break;
3525 1.7 christos }
3526 1.10 christos }
3527 1.7 christos
3528 1.1 christos return true;
3529 1.7 christos }
3530 1.1 christos
3531 1.1 christos /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3533 1.10 christos and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3534 1.10 christos bool
3535 1.10 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3536 1.10 christos {
3537 1.10 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3538 1.10 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3539 1.10 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3540 1.10 christos bool ret = true;
3541 1.10 christos bool warn_only;
3542 1.10 christos
3543 1.10 christos /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
3544 1.1 christos libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
3545 1.1 christos but actually support more than one variant. For example, glibc
3546 1.1 christos typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
3547 1.1 christos but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
3548 1.1 christos The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
3549 1.1 christos object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
3550 1.7 christos layer objects and only from there call into the shared library. */
3551 1.1 christos warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
3552 1.1 christos
3553 1.7 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3554 1.7 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3555 1.7 christos
3556 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3557 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3558 1.7 christos
3559 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3560 1.7 christos {
3561 1.10 christos int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3562 1.10 christos int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3563 1.10 christos static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3564 1.10 christos
3565 1.10 christos if (in_fp == 0)
3566 1.10 christos ;
3567 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 0)
3568 1.7 christos {
3569 1.7 christos if (!warn_only)
3570 1.7 christos {
3571 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3572 1.7 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3573 1.7 christos last_fp = ibfd;
3574 1.10 christos }
3575 1.7 christos }
3576 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3577 1.7 christos {
3578 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3579 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3580 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3581 1.7 christos last_fp, ibfd);
3582 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3583 1.7 christos }
3584 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3585 1.7 christos {
3586 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3587 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3588 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3589 1.7 christos ibfd, last_fp);
3590 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3591 1.7 christos }
3592 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3593 1.7 christos {
3594 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3595 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3596 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3597 1.7 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3598 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3599 1.7 christos }
3600 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3601 1.7 christos {
3602 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3603 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3604 1.1 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3605 1.7 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3606 1.7 christos ret = warn_only;
3607 1.10 christos }
3608 1.10 christos
3609 1.10 christos in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3610 1.10 christos out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3611 1.10 christos if (in_fp == 0)
3612 1.10 christos ;
3613 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 0)
3614 1.7 christos {
3615 1.7 christos if (!warn_only)
3616 1.7 christos {
3617 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3618 1.7 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3619 1.7 christos last_ld = ibfd;
3620 1.10 christos }
3621 1.7 christos }
3622 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3623 1.7 christos {
3624 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3625 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3626 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3627 1.7 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3628 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3629 1.7 christos }
3630 1.7 christos else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3631 1.7 christos {
3632 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3633 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3634 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3635 1.7 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3636 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3637 1.7 christos }
3638 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3639 1.7 christos {
3640 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3641 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3642 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3643 1.7 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3644 1.10 christos ret = warn_only;
3645 1.7 christos }
3646 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3647 1.7 christos {
3648 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3649 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3650 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3651 1.7 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3652 1.1 christos ret = warn_only;
3653 1.7 christos }
3654 1.7 christos }
3655 1.7 christos
3656 1.7 christos if (!ret)
3657 1.7 christos {
3658 1.10 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3659 1.7 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3660 1.7 christos }
3661 1.7 christos return ret;
3662 1.7 christos }
3663 1.7 christos
3664 1.10 christos /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3665 1.7 christos there are conflicting attributes. */
3666 1.7 christos static bool
3667 1.10 christos ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3668 1.7 christos {
3669 1.7 christos bfd *obfd;
3670 1.7 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3671 1.7 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3672 1.1 christos bool ret;
3673 1.1 christos
3674 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3675 1.1 christos return false;
3676 1.1 christos
3677 1.10 christos obfd = info->output_bfd;
3678 1.1 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3679 1.1 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3680 1.7 christos
3681 1.7 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3682 1.7 christos merge non-conflicting ones. */
3683 1.1 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3684 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3685 1.7 christos ret = true;
3686 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3687 1.1 christos {
3688 1.7 christos int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3689 1.7 christos int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3690 1.7 christos static bfd *last_vec;
3691 1.1 christos
3692 1.1 christos if (in_vec == 0)
3693 1.1 christos ;
3694 1.1 christos else if (out_vec == 0)
3695 1.1 christos {
3696 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3697 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_vec;
3698 1.1 christos last_vec = ibfd;
3699 1.7 christos }
3700 1.7 christos /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3701 1.7 christos without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3702 1.7 christos alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3703 1.7 christos not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3704 1.7 christos case too. */
3705 1.7 christos else if (in_vec == 1)
3706 1.7 christos ;
3707 1.7 christos else if (out_vec == 1)
3708 1.7 christos {
3709 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3710 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_vec;
3711 1.7 christos last_vec = ibfd;
3712 1.10 christos }
3713 1.7 christos else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3714 1.7 christos {
3715 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3716 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3717 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3718 1.7 christos last_vec, ibfd);
3719 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3720 1.7 christos ret = false;
3721 1.10 christos }
3722 1.7 christos else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3723 1.1 christos {
3724 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3725 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3726 1.1 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3727 1.1 christos ibfd, last_vec);
3728 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3729 1.1 christos ret = false;
3730 1.1 christos }
3731 1.7 christos }
3732 1.7 christos
3733 1.7 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3734 1.7 christos and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3735 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3736 1.1 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3737 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3738 1.7 christos {
3739 1.7 christos int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3740 1.7 christos int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3741 1.7 christos static bfd *last_struct;
3742 1.7 christos
3743 1.7 christos if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3744 1.7 christos ;
3745 1.7 christos else if (out_struct == 0)
3746 1.7 christos {
3747 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3748 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_struct;
3749 1.7 christos last_struct = ibfd;
3750 1.10 christos }
3751 1.7 christos else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3752 1.7 christos {
3753 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3754 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3755 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3756 1.7 christos "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3757 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3758 1.7 christos ret = false;
3759 1.10 christos }
3760 1.7 christos else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3761 1.7 christos {
3762 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3763 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3764 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3765 1.10 christos "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3766 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3767 1.1 christos ret = false;
3768 1.1 christos }
3769 1.7 christos }
3770 1.1 christos if (!ret)
3771 1.1 christos {
3772 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3773 1.1 christos return false;
3774 1.1 christos }
3775 1.10 christos
3776 1.7 christos /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3777 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3778 1.7 christos }
3779 1.1 christos
3780 1.1 christos /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3781 1.10 christos object file when linking. */
3782 1.1 christos
3783 1.1 christos static bool
3784 1.10 christos ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3785 1.1 christos {
3786 1.1 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3787 1.7 christos flagword old_flags;
3788 1.10 christos flagword new_flags;
3789 1.1 christos bool error;
3790 1.7 christos
3791 1.10 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3792 1.10 christos return true;
3793 1.10 christos
3794 1.10 christos /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3795 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3796 1.1 christos return false;
3797 1.1 christos
3798 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3799 1.1 christos return false;
3800 1.1 christos
3801 1.10 christos if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
3802 1.1 christos return true;
3803 1.1 christos
3804 1.1 christos new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3805 1.1 christos old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3806 1.1 christos if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3807 1.1 christos {
3808 1.1 christos /* First call, no flags set. */
3809 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
3810 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3811 1.1 christos }
3812 1.1 christos
3813 1.1 christos /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3814 1.10 christos else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3815 1.1 christos ;
3816 1.1 christos
3817 1.1 christos /* Incompatible flags. */
3818 1.10 christos else
3819 1.7 christos {
3820 1.7 christos /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3821 1.1 christos to be linked with either. */
3822 1.1 christos error = false;
3823 1.1 christos if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3824 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3825 1.1 christos {
3826 1.10 christos error = true;
3827 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3828 1.7 christos (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3829 1.1 christos "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3830 1.1 christos }
3831 1.1 christos else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3832 1.1 christos && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3833 1.1 christos {
3834 1.1 christos error = true;
3835 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3836 1.1 christos (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3837 1.1 christos "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3838 1.1 christos }
3839 1.1 christos
3840 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3841 1.1 christos if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3842 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3843 1.1 christos
3844 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3845 1.1 christos but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3846 1.1 christos if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3847 1.1 christos && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3848 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3849 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3850 1.1 christos
3851 1.1 christos /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3852 1.1 christos any module uses it. */
3853 1.10 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3854 1.7 christos
3855 1.7 christos new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3856 1.7 christos old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3857 1.7 christos
3858 1.7 christos /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3859 1.1 christos if (new_flags != old_flags)
3860 1.1 christos {
3861 1.1 christos error = true;
3862 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3863 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3864 1.10 christos (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3865 1.1 christos "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3866 1.1 christos ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3867 1.1 christos }
3868 1.10 christos
3869 1.1 christos if (error)
3870 1.1 christos {
3871 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3872 1.7 christos return false;
3873 1.7 christos }
3874 1.7 christos }
3875 1.7 christos
3876 1.3 christos return true;
3877 1.7 christos }
3878 1.10 christos
3879 1.7 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
3880 1.9 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3881 1.7 christos asection *input_section,
3882 1.10 christos unsigned long offset,
3883 1.10 christos bfd_byte *loc,
3884 1.7 christos bfd_vma value,
3885 1.9 christos split16_format_type split16_format,
3886 1.7 christos bool fixup)
3887 1.7 christos {
3888 1.7 christos unsigned int insn, opcode;
3889 1.7 christos
3890 1.7 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
3891 1.7 christos return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3892 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3893 1.7 christos opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3894 1.7 christos if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3895 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3896 1.7 christos || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3897 1.7 christos || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3898 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3899 1.7 christos {
3900 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3901 1.7 christos {
3902 1.7 christos if (fixup)
3903 1.7 christos split16_format = split16a_type;
3904 1.7 christos else
3905 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3906 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3907 1.7 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3908 1.7 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3909 1.7 christos }
3910 1.7 christos }
3911 1.7 christos else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3912 1.7 christos || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3913 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3914 1.7 christos || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3915 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3916 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3917 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3918 1.7 christos {
3919 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3920 1.7 christos {
3921 1.7 christos if (fixup)
3922 1.9 christos split16_format = split16d_type;
3923 1.9 christos else
3924 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
3925 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3926 1.9 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3927 1.9 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3928 1.9 christos }
3929 1.9 christos }
3930 1.9 christos if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3931 1.9 christos {
3932 1.9 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3933 1.9 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3934 1.9 christos if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3935 1.9 christos {
3936 1.9 christos /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3937 1.9 christos insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3938 1.7 christos insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3939 1.7 christos }
3940 1.10 christos }
3941 1.7 christos else
3942 1.1 christos {
3943 1.7 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3944 1.7 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3945 1.1 christos }
3946 1.7 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3947 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3948 1.3 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
3949 1.7 christos }
3950 1.7 christos
3951 1.7 christos static void
3952 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3953 1.7 christos {
3954 1.7 christos unsigned int insn;
3955 1.3 christos
3956 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3957 1.1 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3958 1.1 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3959 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3960 1.1 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3961 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3962 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3963 1.1 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3964 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3965 1.1 christos }
3966 1.1 christos
3967 1.1 christos
3968 1.1 christos /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3970 1.1 christos Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3971 1.1 christos int
3972 1.1 christos ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3973 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
3974 1.1 christos {
3975 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3976 1.1 christos flagword flags;
3977 1.3 christos
3978 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3979 1.1 christos
3980 1.10 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3981 1.1 christos {
3982 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3983 1.1 christos
3984 1.1 christos if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3985 1.7 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3986 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3987 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3988 1.1 christos && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3989 1.1 christos false, false, true)) != NULL
3990 1.1 christos && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3991 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt)
3992 1.1 christos && h->ref_regular
3993 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3994 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3995 1.1 christos {
3996 1.3 christos /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3997 1.1 christos secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3998 1.1 christos function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3999 1.1 christos r30 to be set up. */
4000 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4001 1.1 christos }
4002 1.1 christos else
4003 1.1 christos {
4004 1.3 christos bfd *ibfd;
4005 1.1 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4006 1.1 christos
4007 1.1 christos /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4008 1.1 christos Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4009 1.1 christos without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4010 1.1 christos --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4011 1.1 christos if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4012 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4013 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4014 1.1 christos if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4015 1.1 christos {
4016 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4017 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4018 1.1 christos else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4019 1.11 christos {
4020 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4021 1.11 christos htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4022 1.11 christos break;
4023 1.11 christos }
4024 1.11 christos }
4025 1.11 christos htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4026 1.11 christos }
4027 1.11 christos }
4028 1.11 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
4029 1.11 christos {
4030 1.11 christos if (!info->user_warn_rwx_segments)
4031 1.11 christos info->no_warn_rwx_segments = 1;
4032 1.1 christos if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW
4033 1.1 christos || (htab->params->plt_style != PLT_OLD
4034 1.1 christos && !info->no_warn_rwx_segments))
4035 1.1 christos {
4036 1.1 christos if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4037 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4038 1.1 christos else
4039 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4040 1.1 christos }
4041 1.1 christos }
4042 1.7 christos
4043 1.9 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4044 1.1 christos
4045 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4046 1.1 christos {
4047 1.7 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4048 1.9 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4049 1.1 christos
4050 1.1 christos /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4051 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4052 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4053 1.1 christos return -1;
4054 1.1 christos
4055 1.9 christos /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4056 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4057 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4058 1.1 christos return -1;
4059 1.1 christos }
4060 1.1 christos else
4061 1.1 christos {
4062 1.1 christos /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4063 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
4064 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4065 1.1 christos return -1;
4066 1.1 christos }
4067 1.1 christos return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4068 1.1 christos }
4069 1.1 christos
4070 1.1 christos /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4072 1.1 christos relocation. */
4073 1.1 christos
4074 1.1 christos static asection *
4075 1.1 christos ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4076 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
4077 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4078 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4079 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4080 1.1 christos {
4081 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
4082 1.10 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4083 1.7 christos {
4084 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4085 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4086 1.7 christos return NULL;
4087 1.7 christos }
4088 1.7 christos
4089 1.7 christos return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4090 1.1 christos }
4091 1.7 christos
4092 1.1 christos static bool
4093 1.7 christos get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4094 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4095 1.7 christos asection **symsecp,
4096 1.7 christos unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4097 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4098 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx,
4099 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd)
4100 1.7 christos {
4101 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4102 1.1 christos
4103 1.7 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4104 1.7 christos {
4105 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4106 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4107 1.7 christos
4108 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4109 1.7 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4110 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4111 1.7 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4112 1.7 christos
4113 1.7 christos if (hp != NULL)
4114 1.7 christos *hp = h;
4115 1.7 christos
4116 1.1 christos if (symp != NULL)
4117 1.1 christos *symp = NULL;
4118 1.7 christos
4119 1.7 christos if (symsecp != NULL)
4120 1.7 christos {
4121 1.7 christos asection *symsec = NULL;
4122 1.7 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4123 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4124 1.7 christos symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4125 1.1 christos *symsecp = symsec;
4126 1.7 christos }
4127 1.7 christos
4128 1.7 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4129 1.7 christos *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4130 1.7 christos }
4131 1.7 christos else
4132 1.7 christos {
4133 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4134 1.10 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4135 1.7 christos
4136 1.1 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4137 1.7 christos {
4138 1.1 christos locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4139 1.7 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4140 1.7 christos locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4141 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4142 1.7 christos 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4143 1.7 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4144 1.1 christos return false;
4145 1.7 christos *locsymsp = locsyms;
4146 1.7 christos }
4147 1.1 christos sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4148 1.7 christos
4149 1.7 christos if (hp != NULL)
4150 1.7 christos *hp = NULL;
4151 1.7 christos
4152 1.1 christos if (symp != NULL)
4153 1.7 christos *symp = sym;
4154 1.7 christos
4155 1.7 christos if (symsecp != NULL)
4156 1.1 christos *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4157 1.7 christos
4158 1.7 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4159 1.7 christos {
4160 1.7 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4161 1.7 christos unsigned char *tls_mask;
4162 1.1 christos
4163 1.7 christos tls_mask = NULL;
4164 1.1 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4165 1.1 christos if (local_got != NULL)
4166 1.10 christos {
4167 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4168 1.1 christos (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4169 1.7 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4170 1.7 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4171 1.1 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4172 1.10 christos }
4173 1.7 christos *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4174 1.1 christos }
4175 1.1 christos }
4176 1.7 christos return true;
4177 1.7 christos }
4178 1.7 christos
4179 1.1 christos /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4181 1.7 christos defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4182 1.10 christos
4183 1.7 christos bool
4184 1.7 christos ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4185 1.7 christos {
4186 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4187 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd;
4188 1.7 christos asection *sec;
4189 1.7 christos bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4190 1.7 christos
4191 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4192 1.7 christos if (htab == NULL)
4193 1.7 christos return false;
4194 1.7 christos
4195 1.7 christos /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4196 1.7 christos reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4197 1.7 christos between the call and its destination. */
4198 1.3 christos limit = 0x1e00000;
4199 1.7 christos low_vma = -1;
4200 1.7 christos high_vma = 0;
4201 1.7 christos for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4202 1.7 christos if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4203 1.7 christos {
4204 1.7 christos if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4205 1.10 christos low_vma = sec->vma;
4206 1.7 christos if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4207 1.7 christos high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4208 1.7 christos }
4209 1.7 christos
4210 1.7 christos /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4211 1.7 christos convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4212 1.7 christos is local. */
4213 1.7 christos if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4214 1.7 christos {
4215 1.7 christos htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4216 1.7 christos return true;
4217 1.7 christos }
4218 1.7 christos
4219 1.7 christos /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4220 1.7 christos call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4221 1.7 christos the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4222 1.7 christos this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4223 1.7 christos will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4224 1.7 christos particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4225 1.7 christos difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4226 1.7 christos linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4227 1.7 christos particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4228 1.7 christos call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4229 1.7 christos the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4230 1.7 christos together except their symbol. */
4231 1.7 christos
4232 1.7 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4233 1.7 christos {
4234 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4235 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4236 1.7 christos
4237 1.7 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4238 1.7 christos continue;
4239 1.7 christos
4240 1.7 christos local_syms = NULL;
4241 1.7 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4242 1.10 christos
4243 1.7 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4244 1.7 christos if (sec->has_pltcall
4245 1.8 rin && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4246 1.7 christos {
4247 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4248 1.7 christos
4249 1.7 christos /* Read the relocations. */
4250 1.7 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4251 1.7 christos info->keep_memory);
4252 1.7 christos if (relstart == NULL)
4253 1.7 christos return false;
4254 1.7 christos
4255 1.7 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4256 1.7 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4257 1.7 christos {
4258 1.7 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4259 1.7 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
4260 1.7 christos asection *sym_sec;
4261 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4262 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4263 1.7 christos unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4264 1.10 christos
4265 1.7 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4266 1.10 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4267 1.7 christos continue;
4268 1.7 christos
4269 1.7 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4270 1.7 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4271 1.7 christos r_symndx, ibfd))
4272 1.7 christos {
4273 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4274 1.7 christos free (relstart);
4275 1.7 christos if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4276 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
4277 1.7 christos return false;
4278 1.7 christos }
4279 1.7 christos
4280 1.7 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4281 1.7 christos {
4282 1.7 christos bfd_vma from, to;
4283 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
4284 1.7 christos to = h->root.u.def.value;
4285 1.7 christos else
4286 1.7 christos to = sym->st_value;
4287 1.7 christos to += (rel->r_addend
4288 1.7 christos + sym_sec->output_offset
4289 1.7 christos + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4290 1.7 christos from = (rel->r_offset
4291 1.7 christos + sec->output_offset
4292 1.7 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
4293 1.7 christos if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4294 1.7 christos *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4295 1.7 christos }
4296 1.7 christos }
4297 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4298 1.7 christos free (relstart);
4299 1.7 christos }
4300 1.10 christos
4301 1.7 christos if (local_syms != NULL
4302 1.7 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4303 1.7 christos {
4304 1.7 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
4305 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
4306 1.7 christos else
4307 1.7 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4308 1.7 christos }
4309 1.7 christos }
4310 1.7 christos
4311 1.7 christos return true;
4312 1.7 christos }
4313 1.10 christos
4314 1.7 christos /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4315 1.10 christos generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4316 1.7 christos
4317 1.7 christos asection *
4318 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4319 1.1 christos {
4320 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4321 1.10 christos
4322 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4323 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4324 1.1 christos false, false, true);
4325 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4326 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
4327 1.1 christos
4328 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4329 1.1 christos {
4330 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4331 1.1 christos opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4332 1.1 christos false, false, true);
4333 1.1 christos if (opt != NULL
4334 1.1 christos && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4335 1.1 christos || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4336 1.7 christos {
4337 1.1 christos /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4338 1.1 christos signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4339 1.1 christos be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4340 1.1 christos make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4341 1.1 christos tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4342 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4343 1.1 christos && tga != NULL
4344 1.1 christos && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4345 1.1 christos || tga->needs_plt)
4346 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4347 1.7 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4348 1.1 christos {
4349 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4350 1.1 christos for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4351 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4352 1.1 christos break;
4353 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL)
4354 1.1 christos {
4355 1.10 christos tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4356 1.1 christos tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4357 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4358 1.1 christos opt->mark = 1;
4359 1.1 christos if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4360 1.1 christos {
4361 1.1 christos /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4362 1.10 christos opt->dynindx = -1;
4363 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4364 1.1 christos opt->dynstr_index);
4365 1.7 christos if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4366 1.7 christos return false;
4367 1.1 christos }
4368 1.7 christos htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4369 1.7 christos }
4370 1.1 christos }
4371 1.1 christos }
4372 1.1 christos else
4373 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
4374 1.1 christos }
4375 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4376 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4377 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4378 1.10 christos {
4379 1.1 christos elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4380 1.1 christos elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4381 1.1 christos }
4382 1.1 christos
4383 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4384 1.1 christos }
4385 1.1 christos
4386 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4387 1.1 christos HASH. */
4388 1.1 christos
4389 1.1 christos static bool
4390 1.1 christos branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4391 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4392 1.1 christos const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4393 1.1 christos {
4394 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4395 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4396 1.1 christos unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4397 1.10 christos
4398 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4399 1.10 christos {
4400 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4401 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4402 1.1 christos
4403 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4404 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4405 1.10 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4406 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4407 1.1 christos if (h == hash)
4408 1.1 christos return true;
4409 1.1 christos }
4410 1.1 christos return false;
4411 1.1 christos }
4412 1.1 christos
4413 1.1 christos /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4414 1.3 christos opportunities. */
4415 1.10 christos
4416 1.1 christos bool
4417 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4418 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
4419 1.10 christos {
4420 1.10 christos bfd *ibfd;
4421 1.10 christos asection *sec;
4422 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4423 1.1 christos int pass;
4424 1.1 christos
4425 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4426 1.1 christos return true;
4427 1.1 christos
4428 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4429 1.1 christos if (htab == NULL)
4430 1.3 christos return false;
4431 1.1 christos
4432 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4433 1.1 christos
4434 1.1 christos /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4435 1.1 christos relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4436 1.1 christos followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4437 1.1 christos optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4438 1.1 christos notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4439 1.1 christos adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4440 1.1 christos for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4441 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4442 1.1 christos {
4443 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4444 1.1 christos asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4445 1.10 christos
4446 1.1 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4447 1.1 christos if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4448 1.1 christos {
4449 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4450 1.1 christos int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4451 1.1 christos
4452 1.1 christos /* Read the relocations. */
4453 1.7 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4454 1.7 christos info->keep_memory);
4455 1.10 christos if (relstart == NULL)
4456 1.1 christos return false;
4457 1.1 christos
4458 1.1 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4459 1.1 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4460 1.1 christos {
4461 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4462 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
4463 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4464 1.1 christos unsigned char *tls_mask;
4465 1.1 christos unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4466 1.1 christos bool is_local;
4467 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4468 1.1 christos
4469 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4470 1.9 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4471 1.1 christos {
4472 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4473 1.1 christos
4474 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4475 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4476 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4477 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4478 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4479 1.9 christos }
4480 1.1 christos
4481 1.1 christos is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4482 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4483 1.1 christos /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4484 1.1 christos without marker relocs, then check that each
4485 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4486 1.1 christos that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4487 1.1 christos setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4488 1.1 christos relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4489 1.1 christos if (pass == 0
4490 1.10 christos && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4491 1.1 christos && h != NULL
4492 1.1 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4493 1.1 christos && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4494 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4495 1.1 christos {
4496 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4497 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4498 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4499 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4500 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4501 1.1 christos return true;
4502 1.1 christos }
4503 1.1 christos
4504 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4505 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
4506 1.1 christos {
4507 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4508 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4509 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4510 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
4511 1.1 christos
4512 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4513 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4514 1.1 christos /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4515 1.1 christos defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4516 1.1 christos that turns out to be the case. */
4517 1.7 christos if (!is_local)
4518 1.1 christos continue;
4519 1.1 christos
4520 1.1 christos /* LD -> LE */
4521 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4522 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4523 1.1 christos break;
4524 1.1 christos
4525 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4526 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4527 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4528 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
4529 1.1 christos
4530 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4531 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4532 1.1 christos if (is_local)
4533 1.1 christos /* GD -> LE */
4534 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4535 1.1 christos else
4536 1.1 christos /* GD -> IE */
4537 1.1 christos tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4538 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4539 1.1 christos break;
4540 1.1 christos
4541 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4542 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4543 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4544 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4545 1.9 christos if (is_local)
4546 1.9 christos {
4547 1.9 christos /* IE -> LE */
4548 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4549 1.7 christos tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4550 1.7 christos break;
4551 1.7 christos }
4552 1.7 christos else
4553 1.7 christos continue;
4554 1.7 christos
4555 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4556 1.7 christos if (!is_local)
4557 1.7 christos continue;
4558 1.7 christos /* Fall through. */
4559 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4560 1.7 christos if (rel + 1 < relend
4561 1.7 christos && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4562 1.7 christos {
4563 1.7 christos if (pass != 0
4564 1.7 christos && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4565 1.7 christos {
4566 1.7 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4567 1.7 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4568 1.7 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4569 1.7 christos {
4570 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4571 1.7 christos
4572 1.7 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4573 1.7 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4574 1.7 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4575 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4576 1.7 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4577 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
4578 1.7 christos {
4579 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4580 1.7 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
4581 1.7 christos
4582 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4583 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
4584 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4585 1.1 christos got2, addend);
4586 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL
4587 1.1 christos && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4588 1.10 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4589 1.10 christos }
4590 1.10 christos }
4591 1.10 christos }
4592 1.10 christos continue;
4593 1.10 christos }
4594 1.10 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4595 1.10 christos tls_set = 0;
4596 1.10 christos tls_clear = 0;
4597 1.10 christos break;
4598 1.10 christos
4599 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
4600 1.10 christos if (pass == 0)
4601 1.10 christos {
4602 1.10 christos unsigned char buf[4];
4603 1.10 christos unsigned int insn;
4604 1.10 christos bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
4605 1.10 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
4606 1.10 christos off, 4))
4607 1.10 christos {
4608 1.10 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4609 1.10 christos free (relstart);
4610 1.10 christos return false;
4611 1.10 christos }
4612 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
4613 1.10 christos /* addis rt,2,imm */
4614 1.10 christos if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
4615 1.10 christos != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)))
4616 1.10 christos {
4617 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
4618 1.10 christos info->callbacks->minfo
4619 1.1 christos (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
4620 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn);
4621 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4622 1.1 christos }
4623 1.1 christos }
4624 1.1 christos continue;
4625 1.1 christos
4626 1.9 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
4627 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4628 1.1 christos continue;
4629 1.1 christos
4630 1.1 christos default:
4631 1.1 christos continue;
4632 1.1 christos }
4633 1.1 christos
4634 1.1 christos if (pass == 0)
4635 1.1 christos {
4636 1.1 christos if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4637 1.1 christos || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4638 1.1 christos continue;
4639 1.1 christos
4640 1.1 christos if (rel + 1 < relend
4641 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4642 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr))
4643 1.10 christos continue;
4644 1.1 christos
4645 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4646 1.1 christos could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4647 1.1 christos from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4648 1.1 christos the entire optimization. */
4649 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4650 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4651 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4652 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4653 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4654 1.1 christos return true;
4655 1.7 christos }
4656 1.1 christos
4657 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
4658 1.1 christos {
4659 1.1 christos tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4660 1.1 christos got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4661 1.1 christos }
4662 1.7 christos else
4663 1.7 christos {
4664 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4665 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4666 1.1 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4667 1.1 christos
4668 1.7 christos lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4669 1.7 christos if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4670 1.7 christos abort ();
4671 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4672 1.7 christos (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4673 1.7 christos lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4674 1.7 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4675 1.7 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4676 1.9 christos got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4677 1.7 christos }
4678 1.7 christos
4679 1.7 christos /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4680 1.7 christos without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4681 1.9 christos found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4682 1.7 christos marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4683 1.7 christos broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4684 1.7 christos indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4685 1.7 christos Disable optimization in this case. */
4686 1.7 christos if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4687 1.7 christos && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4688 1.7 christos && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4689 1.7 christos != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4690 1.7 christos continue;
4691 1.7 christos
4692 1.7 christos if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4693 1.7 christos {
4694 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4695 1.9 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
4696 1.9 christos
4697 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4698 1.1 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4699 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4700 1.1 christos addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4701 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4702 1.1 christos got2, addend);
4703 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4704 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4705 1.1 christos }
4706 1.1 christos if (tls_clear == 0)
4707 1.1 christos continue;
4708 1.1 christos
4709 1.1 christos if (tls_set == 0)
4710 1.1 christos {
4711 1.1 christos /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4712 1.1 christos if (*got_count > 0)
4713 1.10 christos *got_count -= 1;
4714 1.1 christos }
4715 1.1 christos
4716 1.7 christos *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4717 1.7 christos *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4718 1.7 christos }
4719 1.7 christos
4720 1.10 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4721 1.7 christos free (relstart);
4722 1.7 christos }
4723 1.7 christos }
4724 1.7 christos return true;
4725 1.7 christos }
4726 1.10 christos
4727 1.10 christos /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4729 1.7 christos aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4730 1.7 christos size_dynamic_sections. */
4731 1.10 christos
4732 1.7 christos static bool
4733 1.7 christos alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4734 1.7 christos {
4735 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4736 1.10 christos do
4737 1.7 christos {
4738 1.7 christos if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4739 1.7 christos return true;
4740 1.7 christos eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4741 1.10 christos } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4742 1.7 christos
4743 1.10 christos return false;
4744 1.10 christos }
4745 1.1 christos
4746 1.1 christos /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4747 1.1 christos
4748 1.1 christos static bool
4749 1.1 christos pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4750 1.1 christos {
4751 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4752 1.1 christos
4753 1.10 christos for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4754 1.1 christos if (p->pc_count != 0)
4755 1.1 christos return true;
4756 1.1 christos return false;
4757 1.1 christos }
4758 1.1 christos
4759 1.1 christos /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4760 1.1 christos regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4761 1.1 christos dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4762 1.1 christos change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4763 1.1 christos understand. */
4764 1.1 christos
4765 1.1 christos static bool
4766 1.1 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4767 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4768 1.1 christos {
4769 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4770 1.7 christos asection *s;
4771 1.1 christos
4772 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
4773 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4774 1.1 christos h->root.root.string);
4775 1.1 christos #endif
4776 1.1 christos
4777 1.1 christos /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4778 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4779 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4780 1.10 christos && (h->needs_plt
4781 1.7 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4782 1.7 christos || h->is_weakalias
4783 1.7 christos || (h->def_dynamic
4784 1.7 christos && h->ref_regular
4785 1.10 christos && !h->def_regular)));
4786 1.7 christos
4787 1.1 christos /* Deal with function syms. */
4788 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4789 1.1 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4790 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt)
4791 1.1 christos {
4792 1.1 christos bool local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4793 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4794 1.1 christos /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4795 1.7 christos function symbol is local. */
4796 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4797 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4798 1.7 christos
4799 1.1 christos /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4800 1.1 christos won't need a .plt entry. */
4801 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4802 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4803 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4804 1.1 christos break;
4805 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL
4806 1.1 christos || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4807 1.1 christos && local
4808 1.1 christos && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4809 1.1 christos || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4810 1.1 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4811 1.1 christos {
4812 1.3 christos /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4813 1.1 christos
4814 1.1 christos 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4815 1.1 christos can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4816 1.3 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4817 1.3 christos
4818 1.3 christos 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4819 1.7 christos
4820 1.7 christos 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4821 1.7 christos will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4822 1.7 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4823 1.7 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
4824 1.7 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4825 1.7 christos }
4826 1.7 christos else
4827 1.7 christos {
4828 1.7 christos /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4829 1.10 christos doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4830 1.3 christos executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4831 1.10 christos be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4832 1.3 christos (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4833 1.3 christos through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4834 1.7 christos reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4835 1.7 christos resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4836 1.7 christos than link time. */
4837 1.7 christos if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4838 1.7 christos || (h->non_got_ref
4839 1.7 christos && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4840 1.7 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4841 1.7 christos && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4842 1.10 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4843 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4844 1.3 christos {
4845 1.7 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4846 1.10 christos /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4847 1.1 christos isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4848 1.1 christos if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4849 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4850 1.1 christos }
4851 1.1 christos else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4852 1.1 christos /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4853 1.1 christos plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4854 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4855 1.1 christos }
4856 1.7 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4857 1.7 christos /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4858 1.7 christos return true;
4859 1.7 christos }
4860 1.7 christos else
4861 1.7 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4862 1.7 christos
4863 1.10 christos /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4864 1.10 christos processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4865 1.1 christos real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4866 1.1 christos if (h->is_weakalias)
4867 1.1 christos {
4868 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4869 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4870 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4871 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4872 1.1 christos if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4873 1.1 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4874 1.3 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4875 1.3 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4876 1.3 christos return true;
4877 1.10 christos }
4878 1.3 christos
4879 1.1 christos /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4880 1.1 christos is not a function. */
4881 1.1 christos
4882 1.1 christos /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4883 1.3 christos only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4884 1.3 christos For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4885 1.10 christos be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4886 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4887 1.3 christos {
4888 1.3 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4889 1.3 christos return true;
4890 1.3 christos }
4891 1.3 christos
4892 1.3 christos /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4893 1.3 christos GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4894 1.3 christos if (!h->non_got_ref)
4895 1.3 christos {
4896 1.3 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4897 1.3 christos return true;
4898 1.3 christos }
4899 1.3 christos
4900 1.10 christos /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4901 1.3 christos .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4902 1.3 christos definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4903 1.3 christos are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4904 1.3 christos if (h->protected_def)
4905 1.10 christos {
4906 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4907 1.7 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4908 1.1 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4909 1.1 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4910 1.1 christos && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4911 1.1 christos htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4912 1.1 christos return true;
4913 1.1 christos }
4914 1.1 christos
4915 1.10 christos /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4916 1.1 christos if (info->nocopyreloc)
4917 1.7 christos return true;
4918 1.10 christos
4919 1.1 christos /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4920 1.1 christos we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4921 1.1 christos We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4922 1.1 christos doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4923 1.1 christos relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4924 1.1 christos executable. */
4925 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4926 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4927 1.1 christos && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4928 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
4929 1.1 christos && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4930 1.1 christos return true;
4931 1.1 christos
4932 1.1 christos /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4933 1.1 christos become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4934 1.7 christos an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4935 1.7 christos object will contain position independent code, so all references
4936 1.1 christos from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4937 1.7 christos offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4938 1.1 christos determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4939 1.1 christos both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4940 1.1 christos same memory location for the variable.
4941 1.1 christos
4942 1.1 christos Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4943 1.1 christos must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4944 1.7 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4945 1.7 christos s = htab->dynsbss;
4946 1.7 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4947 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4948 1.1 christos else
4949 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4950 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4951 1.1 christos
4952 1.7 christos if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4953 1.1 christos {
4954 1.1 christos asection *srel;
4955 1.1 christos
4956 1.1 christos /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4957 1.1 christos linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4958 1.7 christos and into the runtime process image. */
4959 1.10 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4960 1.3 christos srel = htab->relsbss;
4961 1.1 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4962 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4963 1.1 christos else
4964 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4965 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4966 1.1 christos srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4967 1.1 christos h->needs_copy = 1;
4968 1.1 christos }
4969 1.10 christos
4970 1.1 christos /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4971 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4972 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4973 1.1 christos }
4974 1.1 christos
4975 1.1 christos /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4977 1.1 christos xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4978 1.1 christos specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4979 1.1 christos is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4980 1.3 christos xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4981 1.1 christos
4982 1.1 christos static bool
4983 1.1 christos add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4984 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4985 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
4986 1.1 christos {
4987 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4988 1.1 christos size_t len1, len2, len3;
4989 1.1 christos char *name;
4990 1.1 christos const char *stub;
4991 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4992 1.10 christos
4993 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4994 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4995 1.1 christos else
4996 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_call32.";
4997 1.1 christos
4998 1.10 christos len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4999 1.1 christos len2 = strlen (stub);
5000 1.10 christos len3 = 0;
5001 1.1 christos if (ent->sec)
5002 1.1 christos len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
5003 1.1 christos name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
5004 1.1 christos if (name == NULL)
5005 1.1 christos return false;
5006 1.1 christos sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
5007 1.1 christos if (ent->sec)
5008 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
5009 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
5010 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
5011 1.3 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false);
5012 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5013 1.10 christos return false;
5014 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5015 1.1 christos {
5016 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5017 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5018 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
5019 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5020 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5021 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5022 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5023 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5024 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5025 1.1 christos }
5026 1.1 christos return true;
5027 1.7 christos }
5028 1.7 christos
5029 1.1 christos /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5030 1.1 christos Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
5031 1.1 christos
5032 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
5033 1.1 christos allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5034 1.1 christos {
5035 1.1 christos bfd_vma where;
5036 1.1 christos unsigned int max_before_header;
5037 1.1 christos
5038 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5039 1.1 christos {
5040 1.7 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5041 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5042 1.1 christos }
5043 1.7 christos else
5044 1.7 christos {
5045 1.1 christos max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5046 1.7 christos if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5047 1.7 christos {
5048 1.1 christos where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5049 1.1 christos htab->got_gap -= need;
5050 1.1 christos }
5051 1.1 christos else
5052 1.1 christos {
5053 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5054 1.7 christos && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5055 1.7 christos {
5056 1.7 christos htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5057 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5058 1.7 christos }
5059 1.7 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5060 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5061 1.7 christos }
5062 1.7 christos }
5063 1.7 christos return where;
5064 1.7 christos }
5065 1.7 christos
5066 1.7 christos /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5067 1.9 christos TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5068 1.7 christos
5069 1.7 christos static inline unsigned int
5070 1.7 christos got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5071 1.7 christos {
5072 1.7 christos unsigned int need;
5073 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5074 1.7 christos need = 4;
5075 1.7 christos else
5076 1.7 christos {
5077 1.10 christos need = 0;
5078 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5079 1.7 christos need += 8;
5080 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5081 1.7 christos need += 4;
5082 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5083 1.7 christos need += 4;
5084 1.7 christos }
5085 1.7 christos return need;
5086 1.7 christos }
5087 1.7 christos
5088 1.7 christos /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5089 1.7 christos
5090 1.7 christos static bool
5091 1.10 christos ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5092 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5093 1.10 christos {
5094 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5095 1.10 christos
5096 1.10 christos if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5097 1.10 christos && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5098 1.10 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5099 1.10 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5100 1.10 christos && h->dynindx == -1
5101 1.10 christos && !h->forced_local
5102 1.10 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5103 1.10 christos return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5104 1.7 christos return true;
5105 1.7 christos }
5106 1.1 christos
5107 1.1 christos /* Choose whether to use htab->iplt or htab->pltlocal rather than the
5108 1.10 christos usual htab->elf.splt section for a PLT entry. */
5109 1.1 christos
5110 1.1 christos static inline
5111 1.1 christos bool use_local_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5112 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5113 1.1 christos {
5114 1.1 christos return (h == NULL
5115 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1
5116 1.1 christos || !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created);
5117 1.10 christos }
5118 1.1 christos
5119 1.1 christos /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5120 1.1 christos
5121 1.3 christos static bool
5122 1.3 christos allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5123 1.3 christos {
5124 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5125 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5126 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5127 1.3 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5128 1.1 christos
5129 1.1 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5130 1.7 christos return true;
5131 1.10 christos
5132 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5133 1.11 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5134 1.11 christos if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5135 1.7 christos || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5136 1.1 christos && !eh->elf.def_regular
5137 1.9 christos && eh->elf.protected_def
5138 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha
5139 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo
5140 1.7 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5141 1.7 christos {
5142 1.7 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5143 1.11 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5144 1.11 christos return false;
5145 1.11 christos
5146 1.11 christos unsigned int need = got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5147 1.1 christos unsigned int rel_need = need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5148 1.1 christos if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5149 1.1 christos {
5150 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5151 1.1 christos /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5152 1.1 christos always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5153 1.9 christos a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5154 1.9 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5155 1.9 christos else
5156 1.10 christos {
5157 1.10 christos need += 8;
5158 1.7 christos rel_need += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5159 1.7 christos }
5160 1.7 christos }
5161 1.7 christos if (need == 0)
5162 1.7 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5163 1.7 christos else
5164 1.9 christos {
5165 1.7 christos eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5166 1.3 christos if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5167 1.7 christos && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5168 1.11 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)
5169 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5170 1.1 christos && !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root))
5171 1.1 christos || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5172 1.1 christos && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5173 1.1 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5174 1.1 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5175 1.7 christos {
5176 1.7 christos asection *rsec;
5177 1.7 christos
5178 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5179 1.10 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5180 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5181 1.7 christos rsec->size += rel_need;
5182 1.7 christos }
5183 1.7 christos }
5184 1.10 christos }
5185 1.7 christos else
5186 1.7 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5187 1.7 christos
5188 1.7 christos /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5189 1.10 christos IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5190 1.7 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5191 1.10 christos && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5192 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5193 1.1 christos
5194 1.1 christos /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5195 1.1 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5196 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5197 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5198 1.1 christos
5199 1.7 christos /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5200 1.1 christos visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5201 1.1 christos else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5202 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5203 1.1 christos
5204 1.1 christos if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5205 1.1 christos ;
5206 1.1 christos
5207 1.1 christos /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5208 1.1 christos dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5209 1.1 christos defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5210 1.1 christos space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5211 1.10 christos changes. */
5212 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5213 1.1 christos {
5214 1.1 christos /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5215 1.1 christos or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5216 1.7 christos generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5217 1.7 christos resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5218 1.7 christos If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5219 1.7 christos then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5220 1.7 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5221 1.7 christos {
5222 1.10 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5223 1.7 christos
5224 1.7 christos for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5225 1.7 christos {
5226 1.10 christos p->count -= p->pc_count;
5227 1.7 christos p->pc_count = 0;
5228 1.7 christos if (p->count == 0)
5229 1.7 christos *pp = p->next;
5230 1.7 christos else
5231 1.7 christos pp = &p->next;
5232 1.7 christos }
5233 1.7 christos }
5234 1.7 christos
5235 1.10 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5236 1.7 christos {
5237 1.7 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5238 1.7 christos
5239 1.10 christos for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5240 1.7 christos {
5241 1.7 christos if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5242 1.7 christos *pp = p->next;
5243 1.7 christos else
5244 1.7 christos pp = &p->next;
5245 1.7 christos }
5246 1.7 christos }
5247 1.10 christos
5248 1.10 christos if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5249 1.10 christos {
5250 1.10 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5251 1.10 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5252 1.7 christos return false;
5253 1.7 christos }
5254 1.7 christos }
5255 1.7 christos else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5256 1.7 christos {
5257 1.7 christos /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5258 1.7 christos symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5259 1.7 christos dynamic. */
5260 1.7 christos if ((h->dynamic_adjusted
5261 1.10 christos || (h->ref_regular
5262 1.7 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5263 1.7 christos && (info->dynamic_undefined_weak > 0
5264 1.10 christos || !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))))
5265 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular
5266 1.7 christos && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5267 1.10 christos && !(h->protected_def
5268 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha
5269 1.7 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo
5270 1.7 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5271 1.10 christos {
5272 1.11 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5273 1.11 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5274 1.11 christos return false;
5275 1.11 christos
5276 1.11 christos if (h->dynindx == -1)
5277 1.11 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5278 1.11 christos }
5279 1.7 christos else
5280 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5281 1.7 christos }
5282 1.7 christos
5283 1.7 christos /* Allocate space. */
5284 1.7 christos for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5285 1.7 christos if (!discarded_section (p->sec))
5286 1.10 christos {
5287 1.7 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5288 1.7 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5289 1.7 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5290 1.7 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5291 1.7 christos }
5292 1.7 christos
5293 1.7 christos /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5294 1.7 christos We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5295 1.7 christos a) is dynamic, or
5296 1.7 christos b) is an ifunc, or
5297 1.10 christos c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5298 1.7 christos d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5299 1.7 christos if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
5300 1.7 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5301 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5302 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt
5303 1.10 christos && h->def_regular
5304 1.10 christos && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5305 1.10 christos && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5306 1.10 christos && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5307 1.10 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5308 1.7 christos {
5309 1.10 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
5310 1.10 christos bool doneone = false;
5311 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5312 1.7 christos
5313 1.7 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5314 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5315 1.7 christos {
5316 1.7 christos asection *s;
5317 1.7 christos bool dyn;
5318 1.7 christos
5319 1.7 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5320 1.7 christos return false;
5321 1.7 christos
5322 1.7 christos dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
5323 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
5324 1.7 christos if (!dyn)
5325 1.7 christos {
5326 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5327 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.iplt;
5328 1.7 christos else
5329 1.7 christos s = htab->pltlocal;
5330 1.7 christos }
5331 1.7 christos
5332 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5333 1.7 christos {
5334 1.7 christos if (!doneone)
5335 1.7 christos {
5336 1.7 christos plt_offset = s->size;
5337 1.7 christos s->size += 4;
5338 1.7 christos }
5339 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5340 1.7 christos
5341 1.7 christos if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5342 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5343 1.7 christos else
5344 1.7 christos {
5345 1.7 christos s = htab->glink;
5346 1.7 christos if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5347 1.7 christos {
5348 1.7 christos glink_offset = s->size;
5349 1.7 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5350 1.10 christos }
5351 1.7 christos if (!doneone
5352 1.7 christos && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5353 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic
5354 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular)
5355 1.7 christos {
5356 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s;
5357 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5358 1.7 christos }
5359 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5360 1.7 christos
5361 1.7 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5362 1.7 christos && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5363 1.7 christos return false;
5364 1.7 christos }
5365 1.7 christos }
5366 1.7 christos else
5367 1.7 christos {
5368 1.7 christos if (!doneone)
5369 1.7 christos {
5370 1.7 christos /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5371 1.7 christos for the special first entry. */
5372 1.7 christos if (s->size == 0)
5373 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5374 1.7 christos
5375 1.7 christos /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5376 1.7 christos parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5377 1.7 christos and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5378 1.7 christos word available at the end. */
5379 1.7 christos plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5380 1.7 christos + (htab->plt_slot_size
5381 1.7 christos * ((s->size
5382 1.7 christos - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5383 1.7 christos / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5384 1.7 christos
5385 1.7 christos /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5386 1.1 christos file, and we are not generating a shared
5387 1.7 christos library, then set the symbol to this location
5388 1.7 christos in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5389 1.7 christos relocations, and is required to make
5390 1.7 christos function pointers compare as equal between
5391 1.7 christos the normal executable and the shared library. */
5392 1.7 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5393 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic
5394 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular)
5395 1.7 christos {
5396 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s;
5397 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5398 1.7 christos }
5399 1.1 christos
5400 1.7 christos /* Make room for this entry. */
5401 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5402 1.7 christos /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5403 1.7 christos is allocated. */
5404 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5405 1.7 christos && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5406 1.7 christos / htab->plt_entry_size
5407 1.7 christos > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5408 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5409 1.7 christos }
5410 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5411 1.7 christos }
5412 1.7 christos
5413 1.7 christos /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5414 1.7 christos if (!doneone)
5415 1.7 christos {
5416 1.7 christos if (!dyn)
5417 1.7 christos {
5418 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5419 1.1 christos {
5420 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5421 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5422 1.7 christos }
5423 1.7 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5424 1.7 christos {
5425 1.7 christos s = htab->relpltlocal;
5426 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5427 1.7 christos }
5428 1.7 christos }
5429 1.7 christos else
5430 1.7 christos {
5431 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5432 1.7 christos
5433 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5434 1.7 christos {
5435 1.7 christos /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5436 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5437 1.7 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5438 1.1 christos {
5439 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset
5440 1.7 christos == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5441 1.7 christos {
5442 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size
5443 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5444 1.10 christos * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5445 1.7 christos }
5446 1.7 christos
5447 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size
5448 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5449 1.1 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5450 1.7 christos }
5451 1.1 christos
5452 1.7 christos /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5453 1.7 christos .got.plt. */
5454 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5455 1.1 christos }
5456 1.7 christos }
5457 1.1 christos doneone = true;
5458 1.7 christos }
5459 1.7 christos }
5460 1.1 christos else
5461 1.1 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5462 1.10 christos
5463 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5464 1.1 christos {
5465 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
5466 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
5467 1.1 christos }
5468 1.1 christos }
5469 1.1 christos else
5470 1.1 christos {
5471 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
5472 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
5473 1.1 christos }
5474 1.1 christos
5475 1.1 christos return true;
5476 1.1 christos }
5477 1.1 christos
5478 1.1 christos static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5479 1.1 christos {
5480 1.1 christos 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5481 1.10 christos 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5482 1.3 christos 1, /* CIE version. */
5483 1.1 christos 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5484 1.1 christos 4, /* Code alignment. */
5485 1.1 christos 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5486 1.1 christos 65, /* RA reg. */
5487 1.10 christos 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5488 1.1 christos DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5489 1.1 christos DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5490 1.1 christos };
5491 1.1 christos
5492 1.1 christos /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5493 1.1 christos
5494 1.1 christos static bool
5495 1.1 christos ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5496 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
5497 1.1 christos {
5498 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5499 1.1 christos asection *s;
5500 1.3 christos bool relocs;
5501 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
5502 1.1 christos
5503 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
5504 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5505 1.1 christos #endif
5506 1.1 christos
5507 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5508 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5509 1.1 christos
5510 1.1 christos if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5511 1.1 christos {
5512 1.1 christos /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5513 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5514 1.1 christos {
5515 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5516 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5517 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5518 1.1 christos s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5519 1.1 christos }
5520 1.1 christos }
5521 1.1 christos
5522 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5523 1.1 christos htab->got_header_size = 16;
5524 1.1 christos else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5525 1.10 christos htab->got_header_size = 12;
5526 1.10 christos
5527 1.1 christos /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5528 1.1 christos relocs. */
5529 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5530 1.1 christos {
5531 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5532 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5533 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5534 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5535 1.3 christos char *lgot_masks;
5536 1.1 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5537 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5538 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
5539 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5540 1.11 christos
5541 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5542 1.1 christos continue;
5543 1.1 christos
5544 1.1 christos for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5545 1.1 christos {
5546 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5547 1.10 christos
5548 1.1 christos for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5549 1.1 christos elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5550 1.1 christos p != NULL;
5551 1.1 christos p = p->next)
5552 1.1 christos {
5553 1.1 christos if (discarded_section (p->sec))
5554 1.1 christos {
5555 1.1 christos /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5556 1.1 christos it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5557 1.3 christos linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5558 1.7 christos the relocs too. */
5559 1.1 christos }
5560 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
5561 1.1 christos && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5562 1.1 christos ".tls_vars") == 0)
5563 1.7 christos {
5564 1.7 christos /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5565 1.7 christos handled specially by the loader. */
5566 1.7 christos }
5567 1.7 christos else if (p->count != 0)
5568 1.1 christos {
5569 1.1 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5570 1.1 christos if (p->ifunc)
5571 1.1 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5572 1.1 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5573 1.1 christos if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5574 1.1 christos & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5575 1.1 christos == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5576 1.1 christos {
5577 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5578 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5579 1.1 christos p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5580 1.1 christos }
5581 1.1 christos }
5582 1.10 christos }
5583 1.10 christos }
5584 1.10 christos
5585 1.10 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5586 1.10 christos if (!local_got)
5587 1.10 christos continue;
5588 1.10 christos
5589 1.10 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5590 1.1 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5591 1.10 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5592 1.10 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5593 1.10 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5594 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5595 1.1 christos local_syms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5596 1.7 christos if (local_syms == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
5597 1.7 christos {
5598 1.7 christos local_syms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount,
5599 1.7 christos 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
5600 1.1 christos if (local_syms == NULL)
5601 1.1 christos return false;
5602 1.1 christos }
5603 1.1 christos
5604 1.1 christos for (isym = local_syms;
5605 1.9 christos local_got < end_local_got;
5606 1.9 christos ++local_got, ++lgot_masks, ++isym)
5607 1.10 christos if (*local_got > 0)
5608 1.10 christos {
5609 1.3 christos unsigned int need;
5610 1.7 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5611 1.7 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5612 1.9 christos need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5613 1.7 christos if (need == 0)
5614 1.7 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5615 1.7 christos else
5616 1.7 christos {
5617 1.3 christos *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5618 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5619 1.1 christos && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5620 1.1 christos && bfd_link_executable (info))
5621 1.1 christos && isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
5622 1.1 christos {
5623 1.10 christos asection *srel;
5624 1.1 christos
5625 1.1 christos need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5626 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5627 1.7 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5628 1.7 christos srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5629 1.1 christos srel->size += need;
5630 1.1 christos }
5631 1.10 christos }
5632 1.7 christos }
5633 1.1 christos else
5634 1.1 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5635 1.1 christos
5636 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5637 1.7 christos continue;
5638 1.7 christos
5639 1.7 christos /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5640 1.7 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5641 1.7 christos for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5642 1.7 christos {
5643 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
5644 1.7 christos bool doneone = false;
5645 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5646 1.7 christos
5647 1.1 christos for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5648 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5649 1.1 christos {
5650 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5651 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.iplt;
5652 1.1 christos else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5653 1.1 christos || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5654 1.1 christos {
5655 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5656 1.1 christos continue;
5657 1.7 christos }
5658 1.1 christos else
5659 1.7 christos s = htab->pltlocal;
5660 1.1 christos
5661 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5662 1.1 christos {
5663 1.1 christos plt_offset = s->size;
5664 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5665 1.7 christos }
5666 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5667 1.7 christos
5668 1.7 christos if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5669 1.7 christos {
5670 1.7 christos s = htab->glink;
5671 1.7 christos glink_offset = s->size;
5672 1.7 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5673 1.7 christos }
5674 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5675 1.10 christos
5676 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5677 1.1 christos {
5678 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5679 1.1 christos {
5680 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5681 1.10 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5682 1.10 christos }
5683 1.10 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5684 1.10 christos {
5685 1.10 christos s = htab->relpltlocal;
5686 1.10 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5687 1.10 christos }
5688 1.10 christos doneone = true;
5689 1.10 christos }
5690 1.1 christos }
5691 1.1 christos else
5692 1.1 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5693 1.1 christos }
5694 1.1 christos
5695 1.1 christos if (local_syms != NULL
5696 1.1 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
5697 1.1 christos {
5698 1.9 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
5699 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
5700 1.1 christos else
5701 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
5702 1.1 christos }
5703 1.1 christos }
5704 1.7 christos
5705 1.1 christos /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5706 1.1 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5707 1.1 christos
5708 1.1 christos if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5709 1.1 christos {
5710 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5711 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5712 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5713 1.1 christos }
5714 1.7 christos else
5715 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5716 1.1 christos
5717 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5718 1.1 christos {
5719 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5720 1.1 christos
5721 1.1 christos /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5722 1.3 christos for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5723 1.1 christos or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5724 1.1 christos corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5725 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5726 1.3 christos {
5727 1.3 christos g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5728 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5729 1.3 christos g_o_t += 4;
5730 1.3 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5731 1.3 christos }
5732 1.3 christos
5733 1.3 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5734 1.3 christos }
5735 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5736 1.3 christos {
5737 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5738 1.1 christos
5739 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5740 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5741 1.1 christos }
5742 1.1 christos if (info->emitrelocations)
5743 1.1 christos {
5744 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5745 1.1 christos
5746 1.7 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5747 1.7 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5748 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5749 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5750 1.3 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5751 1.1 christos }
5752 1.1 christos
5753 1.3 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
5754 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0
5755 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5756 1.1 christos {
5757 1.10 christos htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5758 1.1 christos /* Space for the branch table. */
5759 1.10 christos htab->glink->size
5760 1.1 christos += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5761 1.1 christos /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5762 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5763 1.1 christos ? 63 : 15);
5764 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5765 1.1 christos
5766 1.1 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5767 1.1 christos {
5768 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5769 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5770 1.3 christos true, false, false);
5771 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5772 1.1 christos return false;
5773 1.10 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5774 1.1 christos {
5775 1.10 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5776 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5777 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5778 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5779 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5780 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5781 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5782 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5783 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5784 1.1 christos }
5785 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5786 1.3 christos true, false, false);
5787 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5788 1.1 christos return false;
5789 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5790 1.1 christos {
5791 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5792 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5793 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5794 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5795 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5796 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5797 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5798 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5799 1.3 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5800 1.1 christos }
5801 1.1 christos }
5802 1.1 christos }
5803 1.1 christos
5804 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
5805 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0
5806 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5807 1.1 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5808 1.1 christos && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5809 1.10 christos {
5810 1.1 christos s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5811 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5812 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5813 1.1 christos {
5814 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5815 1.1 christos if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5816 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5817 1.7 christos }
5818 1.7 christos }
5819 1.1 christos
5820 1.1 christos /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5821 1.1 christos Allocate memory for them. */
5822 1.1 christos relocs = false;
5823 1.1 christos for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5824 1.10 christos {
5825 1.1 christos bool strip_section = true;
5826 1.1 christos
5827 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5828 1.7 christos continue;
5829 1.7 christos
5830 1.1 christos if (s == htab->elf.splt
5831 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5832 1.7 christos {
5833 1.1 christos /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5834 1.7 christos we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5835 1.7 christos It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5836 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5837 1.3 christos strip_section = false;
5838 1.3 christos /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5839 1.3 christos comment below. */
5840 1.3 christos }
5841 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5842 1.1 christos || s == htab->pltlocal
5843 1.3 christos || s == htab->glink
5844 1.1 christos || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5845 1.10 christos || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5846 1.1 christos || s == htab->sbss
5847 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5848 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5849 1.1 christos || s == htab->dynsbss)
5850 1.10 christos {
5851 1.1 christos /* Strip these too. */
5852 1.1 christos }
5853 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5854 1.1 christos || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5855 1.1 christos {
5856 1.1 christos strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5857 1.1 christos }
5858 1.1 christos else if (startswith (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5859 1.1 christos {
5860 1.1 christos if (s->size != 0)
5861 1.1 christos {
5862 1.1 christos /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5863 1.1 christos relocs = true;
5864 1.1 christos
5865 1.1 christos /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5866 1.1 christos to copy relocs into the output file. */
5867 1.1 christos s->reloc_count = 0;
5868 1.1 christos }
5869 1.1 christos }
5870 1.1 christos else
5871 1.1 christos {
5872 1.1 christos /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5873 1.1 christos continue;
5874 1.1 christos }
5875 1.1 christos
5876 1.1 christos if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5877 1.1 christos {
5878 1.1 christos /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5879 1.1 christos output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5880 1.1 christos .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5881 1.1 christos create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5882 1.1 christos before the linker maps input sections to output
5883 1.1 christos sections. The linker does that before
5884 1.10 christos adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5885 1.1 christos function which decides whether anything needs to go
5886 1.1 christos into these sections. */
5887 1.1 christos s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5888 1.1 christos continue;
5889 1.1 christos }
5890 1.1 christos
5891 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5892 1.1 christos continue;
5893 1.1 christos
5894 1.1 christos /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5895 1.1 christos s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5896 1.1 christos if (s->contents == NULL)
5897 1.10 christos return false;
5898 1.10 christos }
5899 1.10 christos
5900 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5901 1.3 christos {
5902 1.3 christos /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5903 1.3 christos values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5904 1.1 christos must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5905 1.1 christos the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5906 1.10 christos dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5907 1.3 christos #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5908 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5909 1.1 christos
5910 1.3 christos if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
5911 1.10 christos relocs))
5912 1.1 christos return false;
5913 1.1 christos
5914 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5915 1.1 christos && htab->glink != NULL
5916 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0)
5917 1.1 christos {
5918 1.1 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5919 1.1 christos return false;
5920 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5921 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5922 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5923 1.1 christos && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5924 1.1 christos return false;
5925 1.1 christos }
5926 1.1 christos }
5927 1.1 christos #undef add_dynamic_entry
5928 1.1 christos
5929 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5930 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5931 1.1 christos {
5932 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5933 1.1 christos bfd_vma val;
5934 1.1 christos
5935 1.1 christos memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5936 1.1 christos /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5937 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5938 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5939 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */
5940 1.1 christos val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5941 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5942 1.3 christos p += 4;
5943 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */
5944 1.1 christos val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5945 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5946 1.1 christos p += 4;
5947 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5948 1.1 christos p += 4;
5949 1.1 christos /* .glink size. */
5950 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5951 1.1 christos p += 4;
5952 1.1 christos /* Augmentation. */
5953 1.1 christos p += 1;
5954 1.1 christos
5955 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5956 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5957 1.1 christos {
5958 1.1 christos bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5959 1.1 christos if (adv < 64)
5960 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5961 1.1 christos else if (adv < 256)
5962 1.1 christos {
5963 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5964 1.1 christos *p++ = adv;
5965 1.1 christos }
5966 1.1 christos else if (adv < 65536)
5967 1.1 christos {
5968 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5969 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5970 1.1 christos p += 2;
5971 1.1 christos }
5972 1.1 christos else
5973 1.1 christos {
5974 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5975 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5976 1.10 christos p += 4;
5977 1.1 christos }
5978 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5979 1.3 christos *p++ = 65;
5980 1.3 christos p++;
5981 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5982 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5983 1.3 christos *p++ = 65;
5984 1.3 christos }
5985 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5986 1.3 christos == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5987 1.3 christos }
5988 1.3 christos
5989 1.3 christos return true;
5990 1.3 christos }
5991 1.3 christos
5992 1.3 christos /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5993 1.3 christos if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5994 1.3 christos
5995 1.3 christos static void
5996 1.3 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5997 1.3 christos {
5998 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5999 1.3 christos
6000 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
6001 1.3 christos {
6002 1.3 christos asection *s;
6003 1.3 christos
6004 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
6005 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6006 1.3 christos {
6007 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6008 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6009 1.3 christos {
6010 1.3 christos sda->def_regular = 0;
6011 1.3 christos /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
6012 1.3 christos sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6013 1.3 christos sda->forced_local = 0;
6014 1.3 christos }
6015 1.3 christos }
6016 1.3 christos }
6017 1.3 christos }
6018 1.3 christos
6019 1.1 christos void
6020 1.1 christos ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6021 1.10 christos {
6022 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6023 1.1 christos
6024 1.1 christos if (htab != NULL)
6025 1.1 christos {
6026 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6027 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6028 1.10 christos }
6029 1.1 christos }
6030 1.1 christos
6031 1.1 christos
6032 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6033 1.1 christos
6034 1.1 christos static bool
6035 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6036 1.1 christos {
6037 1.1 christos if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6038 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
6039 1.1 christos && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6040 1.1 christos || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6041 1.1 christos return false;
6042 1.1 christos
6043 1.3 christos return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6044 1.1 christos }
6045 1.1 christos
6046 1.1 christos #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6048 1.1 christos
6049 1.1 christos /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6050 1.1 christos used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6051 1.1 christos static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6052 1.1 christos {
6053 1.1 christos 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6054 1.1 christos 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6055 1.1 christos 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6056 1.1 christos 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6057 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6058 1.3 christos 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6059 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6060 1.3 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6061 1.3 christos };
6062 1.3 christos
6063 1.3 christos static const int stub_entry[] =
6064 1.3 christos {
6065 1.3 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6066 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6067 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6068 1.10 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6069 1.1 christos };
6070 1.1 christos
6071 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6072 1.10 christos {
6073 1.1 christos unsigned int workaround_size;
6074 1.3 christos unsigned int picfixup_size;
6075 1.1 christos };
6076 1.3 christos
6077 1.1 christos /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6078 1.1 christos icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6079 1.1 christos space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6080 1.1 christos add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6081 1.1 christos
6082 1.1 christos static bool
6083 1.1 christos ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6084 1.1 christos asection *isec,
6085 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6086 1.1 christos bool *again)
6087 1.1 christos {
6088 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup
6089 1.3 christos {
6090 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6091 1.1 christos asection *tsec;
6092 1.10 christos /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6093 1.1 christos relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6094 1.3 christos bfd_vma toff;
6095 1.1 christos bfd_vma trampoff;
6096 1.10 christos };
6097 1.1 christos
6098 1.10 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6099 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6100 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6101 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6102 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6103 1.11 christos struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6104 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6105 1.3 christos unsigned changes = 0;
6106 1.10 christos bool workaround_change;
6107 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6108 1.1 christos bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6109 1.1 christos asection *got2;
6110 1.1 christos bool maybe_pasted;
6111 1.3 christos
6112 1.10 christos *again = false;
6113 1.3 christos
6114 1.3 christos /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6115 1.3 christos if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6116 1.10 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6117 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0
6118 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6119 1.3 christos || isec->size < 4)
6120 1.3 christos return true;
6121 1.3 christos
6122 1.3 christos /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6123 1.3 christos do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6124 1.3 christos anyway. */
6125 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6126 1.3 christos return true;
6127 1.3 christos
6128 1.3 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6129 1.3 christos if (htab == NULL)
6130 1.3 christos return true;
6131 1.3 christos
6132 1.3 christos isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6133 1.3 christos if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6134 1.3 christos isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6135 1.10 christos trampbase = isec->size;
6136 1.3 christos
6137 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6138 1.3 christos || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6139 1.3 christos isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6140 1.1 christos
6141 1.1 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6142 1.1 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6143 1.1 christos {
6144 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6145 1.3 christos {
6146 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6147 1.1 christos = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6148 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6149 1.3 christos return false;
6150 1.3 christos }
6151 1.3 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6152 1.3 christos trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6153 1.3 christos }
6154 1.3 christos
6155 1.3 christos maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6156 1.3 christos || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6157 1.3 christos /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6158 1.3 christos trampoff = trampbase;
6159 1.3 christos if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6160 1.3 christos trampoff += 4;
6161 1.1 christos
6162 1.3 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6163 1.1 christos picfixup_size = 0;
6164 1.3 christos if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6165 1.3 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6166 1.1 christos {
6167 1.3 christos /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6168 1.3 christos if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6169 1.3 christos {
6170 1.3 christos internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6171 1.3 christos link_info->keep_memory);
6172 1.11 christos if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6173 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6174 1.3 christos }
6175 1.3 christos
6176 1.7 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6177 1.3 christos
6178 1.3 christos irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6179 1.3 christos for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6180 1.3 christos {
6181 1.3 christos unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6182 1.3 christos bfd_vma toff, roff;
6183 1.3 christos asection *tsec;
6184 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6185 1.7 christos size_t insn_offset = 0;
6186 1.3 christos bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val, reladdr;
6187 1.3 christos bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6188 1.1 christos unsigned long t0;
6189 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6190 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6191 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **plist;
6192 1.3 christos unsigned char sym_type;
6193 1.3 christos
6194 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
6195 1.3 christos {
6196 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
6197 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6198 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6199 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6200 1.3 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6201 1.3 christos break;
6202 1.3 christos
6203 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
6204 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6205 1.7 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6206 1.7 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6207 1.7 christos break;
6208 1.7 christos
6209 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6210 1.1 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6211 1.7 christos break;
6212 1.7 christos continue;
6213 1.3 christos
6214 1.3 christos default:
6215 1.9 christos continue;
6216 1.9 christos }
6217 1.3 christos
6218 1.3 christos /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6219 1.3 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6220 1.1 christos ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6221 1.1 christos goto error_return;
6222 1.3 christos
6223 1.7 christos if (isym != NULL)
6224 1.7 christos {
6225 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL)
6226 1.3 christos ;
6227 1.3 christos else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6228 1.7 christos tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6229 1.7 christos else
6230 1.7 christos continue;
6231 1.3 christos
6232 1.3 christos toff = isym->st_value;
6233 1.3 christos sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6234 1.3 christos }
6235 1.3 christos else
6236 1.3 christos {
6237 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL)
6238 1.3 christos toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6239 1.3 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6240 1.3 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6241 1.3 christos {
6242 1.3 christos unsigned long indx;
6243 1.3 christos
6244 1.3 christos indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6245 1.3 christos tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6246 1.3 christos toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6247 1.3 christos }
6248 1.3 christos else
6249 1.3 christos continue;
6250 1.3 christos
6251 1.3 christos /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6252 1.3 christos optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6253 1.3 christos branch stub in that case. */
6254 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6255 1.3 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6256 1.3 christos && irel != internal_relocs)
6257 1.3 christos {
6258 1.3 christos unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6259 1.3 christos unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6260 1.3 christos unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6261 1.3 christos
6262 1.3 christos /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6263 1.3 christos R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6264 1.3 christos on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6265 1.3 christos mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6266 1.3 christos if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6267 1.3 christos {
6268 1.3 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6269 1.3 christos
6270 1.3 christos if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6271 1.3 christos {
6272 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6273 1.1 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6274 1.3 christos char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6275 1.3 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6276 1.3 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6277 1.1 christos }
6278 1.3 christos }
6279 1.3 christos else
6280 1.3 christos {
6281 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6282 1.3 christos = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6283 1.3 christos
6284 1.3 christos while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6285 1.3 christos || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6286 1.3 christos th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6287 1.3 christos
6288 1.3 christos tls_mask
6289 1.3 christos = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6290 1.3 christos }
6291 1.1 christos
6292 1.3 christos /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6293 1.3 christos optimised away. */
6294 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6295 1.3 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6296 1.1 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6297 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6298 1.3 christos continue;
6299 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6300 1.3 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6301 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6302 1.3 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6303 1.3 christos continue;
6304 1.1 christos }
6305 1.3 christos
6306 1.3 christos sym_type = h->type;
6307 1.3 christos }
6308 1.3 christos
6309 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6310 1.3 christos {
6311 1.3 christos if (h != NULL
6312 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
6313 1.3 christos && h->protected_def
6314 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6315 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6316 1.3 christos picfixup_size += 12;
6317 1.3 christos continue;
6318 1.3 christos }
6319 1.3 christos
6320 1.3 christos /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6321 1.3 christos match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6322 1.3 christos but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6323 1.3 christos destination used here may be incorrect. */
6324 1.3 christos plist = NULL;
6325 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
6326 1.3 christos {
6327 1.3 christos /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6328 1.3 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6329 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6330 1.1 christos plist = &h->plt.plist;
6331 1.3 christos }
6332 1.3 christos else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6333 1.3 christos && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6334 1.3 christos {
6335 1.1 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6336 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6337 1.3 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6338 1.3 christos plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6339 1.3 christos }
6340 1.3 christos if (plist != NULL)
6341 1.3 christos {
6342 1.3 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
6343 1.3 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
6344 1.3 christos
6345 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6346 1.7 christos addend = irel->r_addend;
6347 1.3 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6348 1.3 christos if (ent != NULL)
6349 1.1 christos {
6350 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6351 1.1 christos || h == NULL
6352 1.3 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6353 1.3 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
6354 1.3 christos {
6355 1.3 christos tsec = htab->glink;
6356 1.3 christos toff = ent->glink_offset;
6357 1.3 christos }
6358 1.9 christos else
6359 1.9 christos {
6360 1.9 christos tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6361 1.9 christos toff = ent->plt.offset;
6362 1.9 christos }
6363 1.9 christos }
6364 1.9 christos }
6365 1.9 christos
6366 1.9 christos /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6367 1.9 christos no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6368 1.9 christos branch overflow. */
6369 1.3 christos if (tsec == isec)
6370 1.3 christos continue;
6371 1.3 christos
6372 1.3 christos /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6373 1.3 christos undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6374 1.3 christos support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6375 1.3 christos putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6376 1.3 christos branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6377 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6378 1.3 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6379 1.3 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6380 1.3 christos && irel->r_addend != 0)
6381 1.3 christos continue;
6382 1.3 christos
6383 1.3 christos /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6384 1.3 christos SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6385 1.3 christos attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6386 1.3 christos branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6387 1.3 christos reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6388 1.3 christos if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6389 1.3 christos {
6390 1.3 christos /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6391 1.3 christos adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6392 1.9 christos passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6393 1.9 christos relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6394 1.3 christos section symbols have been adjusted.)
6395 1.3 christos
6396 1.3 christos gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6397 1.3 christos sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6398 1.3 christos the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6399 1.3 christos a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6400 1.1 christos offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6401 1.9 christos location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6402 1.9 christos other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6403 1.3 christos a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6404 1.3 christos access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6405 1.3 christos location of interest is just "sym". */
6406 1.3 christos if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6407 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6408 1.1 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6409 1.3 christos
6410 1.3 christos toff
6411 1.3 christos = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6412 1.3 christos elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6413 1.3 christos toff);
6414 1.3 christos
6415 1.3 christos if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6416 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6417 1.3 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6418 1.11 christos }
6419 1.1 christos /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6420 1.9 christos else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6421 1.9 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6422 1.9 christos
6423 1.9 christos /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6424 1.9 christos if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6425 1.9 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6426 1.9 christos || tsec->output_section == NULL
6427 1.9 christos || (tsec->owner != NULL
6428 1.9 christos && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6429 1.9 christos continue;
6430 1.3 christos
6431 1.3 christos roff = irel->r_offset;
6432 1.3 christos reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6433 1.3 christos
6434 1.3 christos /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6435 1.3 christos relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6436 1.3 christos fixup can be created at final link.
6437 1.11 christos The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6438 1.3 christos of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6439 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6440 1.3 christos && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6441 1.3 christos < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6442 1.3 christos continue;
6443 1.3 christos
6444 1.1 christos /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6445 1.3 christos if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6446 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6447 1.3 christos /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6448 1.3 christos final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6449 1.1 christos || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6450 1.3 christos {
6451 1.3 christos bfd_vma symaddr;
6452 1.3 christos
6453 1.3 christos symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6454 1.1 christos if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6455 1.3 christos < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6456 1.3 christos continue;
6457 1.3 christos }
6458 1.3 christos
6459 1.3 christos /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6460 1.1 christos for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6461 1.3 christos if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6462 1.3 christos break;
6463 1.3 christos
6464 1.3 christos if (f == NULL)
6465 1.3 christos {
6466 1.3 christos size_t size;
6467 1.3 christos unsigned long stub_rtype;
6468 1.3 christos
6469 1.3 christos val = trampoff - roff;
6470 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6471 1.3 christos /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6472 1.7 christos one. We'll report an error later. */
6473 1.3 christos continue;
6474 1.3 christos
6475 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6476 1.3 christos {
6477 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6478 1.3 christos insn_offset = 12;
6479 1.1 christos }
6480 1.3 christos else
6481 1.3 christos {
6482 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6483 1.3 christos insn_offset = 0;
6484 1.3 christos }
6485 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6486 1.3 christos if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6487 1.3 christos || tsec == htab->glink)
6488 1.3 christos {
6489 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6490 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6491 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6492 1.3 christos }
6493 1.3 christos
6494 1.3 christos /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6495 1.3 christos relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6496 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6497 1.3 christos stub_rtype);
6498 1.3 christos irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6499 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6500 1.1 christos && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6501 1.1 christos irel->r_addend = 0;
6502 1.3 christos
6503 1.3 christos /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6504 1.3 christos f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6505 1.3 christos f->next = branch_fixups;
6506 1.3 christos f->tsec = tsec;
6507 1.3 christos f->toff = toff;
6508 1.1 christos f->trampoff = trampoff;
6509 1.1 christos branch_fixups = f;
6510 1.11 christos
6511 1.11 christos trampoff += size;
6512 1.11 christos changes++;
6513 1.11 christos }
6514 1.11 christos else
6515 1.11 christos {
6516 1.3 christos val = f->trampoff - roff;
6517 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6518 1.1 christos continue;
6519 1.3 christos
6520 1.3 christos /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6521 1.3 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6522 1.1 christos }
6523 1.3 christos
6524 1.1 christos link_info->callbacks->minfo
6525 1.1 christos (_("%pB: Adjusting branch at 0x%V towards \"%s\" in section %s\n"),
6526 1.1 christos abfd, reladdr,
6527 1.3 christos (h && h->root.root.string? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"),
6528 1.3 christos f->tsec->name);
6529 1.3 christos
6530 1.3 christos /* Get the section contents. */
6531 1.3 christos if (contents == NULL)
6532 1.3 christos {
6533 1.3 christos /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6534 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6535 1.3 christos contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6536 1.3 christos /* Go get them off disk. */
6537 1.3 christos else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6538 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6539 1.1 christos }
6540 1.3 christos
6541 1.3 christos /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6542 1.3 christos hit_addr = contents + roff;
6543 1.3 christos switch (r_type)
6544 1.3 christos {
6545 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
6546 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6547 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6548 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6549 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6550 1.1 christos t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6551 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6552 1.1 christos break;
6553 1.3 christos
6554 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
6555 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6556 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6557 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6558 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6559 1.10 christos t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6560 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6561 1.3 christos break;
6562 1.3 christos }
6563 1.3 christos }
6564 1.3 christos
6565 1.3 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6566 1.3 christos {
6567 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6568 1.1 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6569 1.3 christos free (f);
6570 1.3 christos }
6571 1.3 christos }
6572 1.3 christos
6573 1.3 christos workaround_change = false;
6574 1.1 christos newsize = trampoff;
6575 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6576 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6577 1.3 christos || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6578 1.3 christos {
6579 1.3 christos bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6580 1.3 christos unsigned int crossings;
6581 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6582 1.3 christos
6583 1.10 christos addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6584 1.3 christos end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6585 1.3 christos addr &= -pagesize;
6586 1.3 christos crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6587 1.1 christos if (crossings != 0)
6588 1.3 christos {
6589 1.3 christos /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6590 1.1 christos not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6591 1.3 christos previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6592 1.3 christos newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6593 1.3 christos newsize += crossings * 16;
6594 1.3 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6595 1.3 christos {
6596 1.3 christos relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6597 1.3 christos workaround_change = true;
6598 1.1 christos }
6599 1.3 christos /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6600 1.3 christos isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6601 1.1 christos }
6602 1.1 christos newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6603 1.1 christos }
6604 1.1 christos
6605 1.1 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6606 1.1 christos {
6607 1.1 christos picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6608 1.1 christos if (picfixup_size != 0)
6609 1.1 christos relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6610 1.1 christos newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6611 1.1 christos }
6612 1.1 christos
6613 1.1 christos if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6614 1.1 christos isec->size = newsize;
6615 1.1 christos
6616 1.1 christos if (isymbuf != NULL
6617 1.1 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6618 1.1 christos {
6619 1.1 christos if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6620 1.1 christos free (isymbuf);
6621 1.1 christos else
6622 1.1 christos {
6623 1.1 christos /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6624 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6625 1.1 christos }
6626 1.3 christos }
6627 1.1 christos
6628 1.1 christos if (contents != NULL
6629 1.1 christos && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6630 1.1 christos {
6631 1.1 christos if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6632 1.1 christos free (contents);
6633 1.1 christos else
6634 1.1 christos {
6635 1.1 christos /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6636 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6637 1.1 christos }
6638 1.1 christos }
6639 1.1 christos
6640 1.1 christos changes += picfixup_size;
6641 1.1 christos if (changes != 0)
6642 1.1 christos {
6643 1.1 christos /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6644 1.1 christos information for the trampolines. */
6645 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6646 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6647 1.1 christos * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6648 1.1 christos unsigned ix;
6649 1.1 christos
6650 1.1 christos if (!new_relocs)
6651 1.1 christos goto error_return;
6652 1.1 christos memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6653 1.10 christos isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6654 1.1 christos for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6655 1.1 christos {
6656 1.3 christos irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6657 1.10 christos
6658 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6659 1.1 christos }
6660 1.3 christos if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6661 1.3 christos free (internal_relocs);
6662 1.3 christos elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6663 1.3 christos isec->reloc_count += changes;
6664 1.3 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6665 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6666 1.10 christos }
6667 1.1 christos else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6668 1.10 christos free (internal_relocs);
6669 1.1 christos
6670 1.10 christos *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6671 1.1 christos return true;
6672 1.10 christos
6673 1.1 christos error_return:
6674 1.1 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6675 1.1 christos {
6676 1.1 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6677 1.1 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6678 1.1 christos free (f);
6679 1.1 christos }
6680 1.1 christos if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6681 1.1 christos free (isymbuf);
6682 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6683 1.1 christos free (contents);
6684 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6685 1.1 christos free (internal_relocs);
6686 1.1 christos return false;
6687 1.1 christos }
6688 1.1 christos
6689 1.1 christos /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6691 1.1 christos discarded sections. */
6692 1.1 christos
6693 1.1 christos static unsigned int
6694 1.1 christos ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6695 1.1 christos {
6696 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6697 1.1 christos return 0;
6698 1.1 christos
6699 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6700 1.1 christos return 0;
6701 1.1 christos
6702 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6703 1.1 christos }
6704 1.1 christos
6705 1.1 christos /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6707 1.1 christos
6708 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
6709 1.1 christos elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6710 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6711 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6712 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation,
6713 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6714 1.1 christos {
6715 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6716 1.1 christos
6717 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6718 1.1 christos
6719 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
6720 1.1 christos {
6721 1.1 christos /* Handle global symbol. */
6722 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6723 1.1 christos
6724 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6725 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6726 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6727 1.1 christos }
6728 1.1 christos else
6729 1.1 christos {
6730 1.1 christos /* Handle local symbol. */
6731 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6732 1.1 christos
6733 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6734 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6735 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6736 1.1 christos }
6737 1.1 christos
6738 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6739 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
6740 1.1 christos lsect);
6741 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6742 1.1 christos
6743 1.1 christos /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6744 1.1 christos as a "written" flag. */
6745 1.1 christos if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6746 1.1 christos {
6747 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6748 1.1 christos relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6749 1.1 christos lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6750 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6751 1.1 christos }
6752 1.1 christos
6753 1.1 christos relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6754 1.1 christos + lsect->section->output_offset
6755 1.1 christos + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6756 1.7 christos - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6757 1.7 christos
6758 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
6759 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
6760 1.1 christos "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6761 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6762 1.1 christos #endif
6763 1.7 christos
6764 1.7 christos return relocation;
6765 1.7 christos }
6766 1.7 christos
6767 1.7 christos #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6768 1.7 christos #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6769 1.7 christos #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6770 1.7 christos
6771 1.7 christos static void
6772 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6773 1.7 christos asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6774 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
6775 1.7 christos {
6776 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6777 1.7 christos bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6778 1.7 christos bfd_vma plt;
6779 1.7 christos unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6780 1.7 christos
6781 1.7 christos if (h != NULL
6782 1.7 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6783 1.7 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6784 1.7 christos {
6785 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6786 1.1 christos p += 4;
6787 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6788 1.1 christos p += 4;
6789 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6790 1.1 christos p += 4;
6791 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6792 1.1 christos p += 4;
6793 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6794 1.1 christos p += 4;
6795 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6796 1.1 christos p += 4;
6797 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6798 1.1 christos p += 4;
6799 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6800 1.1 christos p += 4;
6801 1.1 christos }
6802 1.1 christos
6803 1.1 christos plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6804 1.1 christos + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6805 1.7 christos + plt_sec->output_offset);
6806 1.1 christos
6807 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6808 1.1 christos {
6809 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0;
6810 1.1 christos
6811 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6812 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend
6813 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6814 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset);
6815 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6816 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6817 1.1 christos
6818 1.7 christos plt -= got;
6819 1.7 christos
6820 1.7 christos if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6821 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6822 1.7 christos else
6823 1.7 christos {
6824 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6825 1.7 christos p += 4;
6826 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6827 1.1 christos }
6828 1.1 christos }
6829 1.1 christos else
6830 1.1 christos {
6831 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6832 1.1 christos p += 4;
6833 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6834 1.1 christos }
6835 1.1 christos p += 4;
6836 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6837 1.1 christos p += 4;
6838 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6839 1.1 christos p += 4;
6840 1.1 christos while (p < end)
6841 1.1 christos {
6842 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6843 1.1 christos p += 4;
6844 1.1 christos }
6845 1.1 christos }
6846 1.1 christos
6847 1.1 christos /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6848 1.1 christos
6849 1.1 christos static bool
6850 1.1 christos is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6851 1.9 christos {
6852 1.1 christos return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6853 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6854 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6855 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6856 1.1 christos }
6857 1.1 christos
6858 1.1 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6859 1.1 christos the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6860 1.1 christos REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6861 1.1 christos
6862 1.1 christos unsigned int
6863 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6864 1.1 christos {
6865 1.1 christos unsigned int rtra;
6866 1.1 christos
6867 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6868 1.1 christos return 0;
6869 1.9 christos
6870 1.1 christos if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6871 1.1 christos rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6872 1.9 christos else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6873 1.1 christos rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6874 1.1 christos else
6875 1.9 christos return 0;
6876 1.1 christos
6877 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6878 1.1 christos /* add -> addi. */
6879 1.1 christos insn = 14 << 26;
6880 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6881 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6882 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6883 1.1 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6884 1.1 christos /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6885 1.1 christos insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6886 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6887 1.1 christos /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6888 1.1 christos insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6889 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6890 1.9 christos /* lwax -> lwa. */
6891 1.9 christos insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
6892 1.9 christos else
6893 1.9 christos return 0;
6894 1.9 christos insn |= rtra;
6895 1.9 christos return insn;
6896 1.9 christos }
6897 1.9 christos
6898 1.9 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6899 1.9 christos the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6900 1.9 christos thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6901 1.9 christos
6902 1.9 christos unsigned int
6903 1.9 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6904 1.9 christos {
6905 1.9 christos if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6906 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6907 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6908 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6909 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6910 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6911 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6912 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6913 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6914 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6915 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6916 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6917 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6918 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6919 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6920 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6921 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6922 1.1 christos && (insn & 3) != 1)
6923 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6924 1.1 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6925 1.1 christos {
6926 1.1 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6927 1.10 christos }
6928 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6929 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6930 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6931 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6932 1.9 christos {
6933 1.9 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6934 1.1 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6935 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6936 1.10 christos insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6937 1.1 christos }
6938 1.1 christos else
6939 1.9 christos insn = 0;
6940 1.9 christos return insn;
6941 1.3 christos }
6942 1.1 christos
6943 1.1 christos static bool
6944 1.11 christos is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6945 1.11 christos {
6946 1.11 christos return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6947 1.11 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6948 1.11 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6949 1.11 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6950 1.11 christos }
6951 1.11 christos
6952 1.11 christos static bool
6953 1.11 christos is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6954 1.11 christos {
6955 1.11 christos return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6956 1.11 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6957 1.11 christos && (insn & 3) == 1));
6958 1.11 christos }
6959 1.11 christos
6960 1.11 christos static bool
6961 1.1 christos swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, bfd_byte *loc, asection *s)
6962 1.1 christos {
6963 1.1 christos if ((size_t) (loc - s->contents) >= s->size)
6964 1.1 christos return false;
6965 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (obfd, rel, loc);
6966 1.1 christos return true;
6967 1.1 christos }
6968 1.1 christos
6969 1.1 christos static bool
6970 1.1 christos count_and_swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, asection *s)
6971 1.1 christos {
6972 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc = s->contents;
6973 1.1 christos loc += s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
6974 1.1 christos return swap_reloc_out (obfd, rel, loc, s);
6975 1.1 christos }
6976 1.1 christos
6977 1.1 christos /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6978 1.1 christos to handle the relocations for a section.
6979 1.1 christos
6980 1.1 christos The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6981 1.1 christos actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6982 1.1 christos zero.
6983 1.1 christos
6984 1.1 christos This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6985 1.1 christos necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6986 1.1 christos relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6987 1.1 christos necessary.
6988 1.1 christos
6989 1.1 christos This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6990 1.10 christos address or the reloc symbol index.
6991 1.1 christos
6992 1.1 christos LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6993 1.1 christos
6994 1.1 christos LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6995 1.1 christos corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6996 1.1 christos
6997 1.1 christos The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6998 1.1 christos via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6999 1.1 christos
7000 1.1 christos When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
7001 1.1 christos STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
7002 1.1 christos going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
7003 1.1 christos section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
7004 1.3 christos accordingly. */
7005 1.1 christos
7006 1.1 christos static int
7007 1.3 christos ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
7008 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
7009 1.10 christos bfd *input_bfd,
7010 1.7 christos asection *input_section,
7011 1.10 christos bfd_byte *contents,
7012 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7013 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7014 1.1 christos asection **local_sections)
7015 1.1 christos {
7016 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7017 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7018 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7019 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7020 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
7021 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7022 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
7023 1.9 christos asection *got2;
7024 1.9 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
7025 1.9 christos bool ret = true;
7026 1.10 christos bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
7027 1.9 christos bool is_vxworks_tls;
7028 1.9 christos unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
7029 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
7030 1.1 christos
7031 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
7032 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7033 1.1 christos "%ld relocations%s",
7034 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section,
7035 1.1 christos (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7036 1.1 christos (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7037 1.1 christos #endif
7038 1.1 christos
7039 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7040 1.1 christos {
7041 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7042 1.1 christos return false;
7043 1.1 christos }
7044 1.3 christos
7045 1.3 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7046 1.3 christos
7047 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7048 1.3 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7049 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7050 1.1 christos
7051 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7052 1.1 christos local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7053 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7054 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7055 1.1 christos /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7056 1.1 christos specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7057 1.1 christos is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7058 1.1 christos && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7059 1.1 christos ".tls_vars"));
7060 1.1 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7061 1.10 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7062 1.10 christos rel = wrel = relocs;
7063 1.1 christos relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7064 1.7 christos for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7065 1.3 christos {
7066 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7067 1.3 christos bfd_vma addend;
7068 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7069 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7070 1.1 christos asection *sec;
7071 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7072 1.10 christos const char *sym_name;
7073 1.10 christos reloc_howto_type *howto;
7074 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
7075 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation;
7076 1.1 christos bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7077 1.1 christos bool unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7078 1.1 christos bool warned;
7079 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7080 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7081 1.1 christos struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7082 1.1 christos
7083 1.1 christos again:
7084 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7085 1.1 christos sym = NULL;
7086 1.10 christos sec = NULL;
7087 1.3 christos h = NULL;
7088 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
7089 1.1 christos warned = false;
7090 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7091 1.3 christos
7092 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7093 1.1 christos {
7094 1.1 christos sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7095 1.1 christos sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7096 1.1 christos sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7097 1.1 christos
7098 1.1 christos relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7099 1.1 christos }
7100 1.1 christos else
7101 1.1 christos {
7102 1.1 christos bool ignored;
7103 1.1 christos
7104 1.3 christos RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7105 1.3 christos r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7106 1.9 christos h, sec, relocation,
7107 1.3 christos unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7108 1.3 christos
7109 1.3 christos sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7110 1.3 christos }
7111 1.3 christos
7112 1.7 christos if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7113 1.3 christos {
7114 1.3 christos /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7115 1.3 christos or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7116 1.3 christos section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7117 1.3 christos howto = NULL;
7118 1.3 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7119 1.3 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7120 1.1 christos
7121 1.1 christos _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7122 1.3 christos contents, rel->r_offset);
7123 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7124 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = 0;
7125 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = 0;
7126 1.1 christos
7127 1.1 christos /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7128 1.1 christos symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7129 1.1 christos non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7130 1.1 christos eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7131 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7132 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7133 1.3 christos wrel--;
7134 1.3 christos
7135 1.3 christos continue;
7136 1.1 christos }
7137 1.1 christos
7138 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7139 1.1 christos {
7140 1.1 christos if (got2 != NULL
7141 1.1 christos && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7142 1.1 christos && rel->r_addend != 0)
7143 1.1 christos {
7144 1.1 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7145 1.1 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7146 1.1 christos rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7147 1.1 christos }
7148 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7149 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7150 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7151 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7152 1.1 christos }
7153 1.1 christos
7154 1.1 christos /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7155 1.1 christos based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7156 1.1 christos RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7157 1.1 christos for the final instruction stream. */
7158 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0;
7159 1.1 christos tls_gd = 0;
7160 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
7161 1.1 christos tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7162 1.1 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7163 1.1 christos {
7164 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7165 1.1 christos char *lgot_masks;
7166 1.1 christos local_plt
7167 1.1 christos = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7168 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7169 1.1 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7170 1.1 christos }
7171 1.1 christos
7172 1.1 christos /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7173 1.1 christos if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7174 1.10 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7175 1.10 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7176 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7177 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7178 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7179 1.7 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7180 1.3 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7181 1.1 christos abort ();
7182 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
7183 1.7 christos {
7184 1.3 christos default:
7185 1.1 christos break;
7186 1.1 christos
7187 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7188 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7189 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7190 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
7191 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7192 1.10 christos {
7193 1.10 christos bfd_vma insn;
7194 1.1 christos
7195 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7196 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7197 1.7 christos insn &= 31 << 21;
7198 1.1 christos insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7199 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7200 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7201 1.7 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7202 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7203 1.1 christos }
7204 1.1 christos break;
7205 1.1 christos
7206 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
7207 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7208 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
7209 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7210 1.1 christos {
7211 1.1 christos bfd_vma insn;
7212 1.1 christos
7213 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7214 1.10 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7215 1.10 christos if (insn == 0)
7216 1.1 christos abort ();
7217 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7218 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7219 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7220 1.1 christos
7221 1.10 christos /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7222 1.10 christos PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7223 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7224 1.1 christos }
7225 1.1 christos break;
7226 1.1 christos
7227 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7228 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7229 1.1 christos tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7230 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7231 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7232 1.1 christos goto tls_gdld_hi;
7233 1.1 christos break;
7234 1.1 christos
7235 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7236 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7237 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7238 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7239 1.1 christos {
7240 1.9 christos tls_gdld_hi:
7241 1.10 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7242 1.10 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7243 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7244 1.1 christos else
7245 1.1 christos {
7246 1.1 christos rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7247 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7248 1.10 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7249 1.10 christos }
7250 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7251 1.1 christos }
7252 1.1 christos break;
7253 1.1 christos
7254 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7255 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7256 1.1 christos tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7257 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7258 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7259 1.1 christos goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7260 1.1 christos break;
7261 1.9 christos
7262 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7263 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7264 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7265 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7266 1.3 christos {
7267 1.3 christos unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7268 1.3 christos bfd_vma offset;
7269 1.3 christos
7270 1.7 christos tls_ldgd_opt:
7271 1.3 christos offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7272 1.1 christos /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7273 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7274 1.1 christos stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7275 1.3 christos reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7276 1.9 christos the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7277 1.10 christos if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7278 1.10 christos && rel + 1 < relend
7279 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7280 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr))
7281 1.1 christos offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7282 1.7 christos /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7283 1.1 christos the destination reg. It may be something other than
7284 1.1 christos the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7285 1.1 christos intervening code. */
7286 1.1 christos insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7287 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7288 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7289 1.1 christos {
7290 1.1 christos /* IE */
7291 1.3 christos insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7292 1.3 christos insn1 |= 32u << 26; /* lwz */
7293 1.1 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
7294 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
7295 1.1 christos {
7296 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7297 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7298 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7299 1.1 christos }
7300 1.1 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7301 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7302 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7303 1.1 christos }
7304 1.1 christos else
7305 1.1 christos {
7306 1.1 christos /* LE */
7307 1.1 christos insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7308 1.1 christos insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7309 1.1 christos if (tls_gd == 0)
7310 1.1 christos {
7311 1.10 christos /* Was an LD reloc. */
7312 1.10 christos for (r_symndx = 0;
7313 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7314 1.1 christos r_symndx++)
7315 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7316 1.1 christos break;
7317 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7318 1.7 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7319 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7320 1.1 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7321 1.7 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7322 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset
7323 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
7324 1.1 christos }
7325 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7326 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7327 1.3 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
7328 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
7329 1.1 christos {
7330 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7331 1.1 christos rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7332 1.1 christos rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7333 1.7 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7334 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7335 1.10 christos }
7336 1.1 christos }
7337 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7338 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7339 1.1 christos if (tls_gd == 0)
7340 1.7 christos {
7341 1.7 christos /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7342 1.7 christos in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7343 1.7 christos goto again;
7344 1.7 christos }
7345 1.7 christos }
7346 1.7 christos break;
7347 1.9 christos
7348 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7349 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7350 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend
7351 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7352 1.1 christos {
7353 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2;
7354 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7355 1.1 christos
7356 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7357 1.1 christos {
7358 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7359 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7360 1.1 christos break;
7361 1.7 christos }
7362 1.1 christos
7363 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7364 1.1 christos {
7365 1.1 christos /* IE */
7366 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7367 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7368 1.1 christos }
7369 1.7 christos else
7370 1.10 christos {
7371 1.10 christos /* LE */
7372 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7373 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7374 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7375 1.7 christos }
7376 1.7 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7377 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7378 1.7 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7379 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7380 1.7 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7381 1.7 christos }
7382 1.1 christos break;
7383 1.1 christos
7384 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7385 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7386 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend
7387 1.1 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7388 1.1 christos {
7389 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2;
7390 1.1 christos
7391 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7392 1.1 christos {
7393 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7394 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7395 1.1 christos break;
7396 1.1 christos }
7397 1.1 christos
7398 1.7 christos for (r_symndx = 0;
7399 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7400 1.1 christos r_symndx++)
7401 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7402 1.1 christos break;
7403 1.3 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7404 1.1 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7405 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7406 1.1 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7407 1.1 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7408 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset
7409 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
7410 1.1 christos
7411 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7412 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7413 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7414 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7415 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7416 1.1 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7417 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7418 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7419 1.7 christos goto again;
7420 1.1 christos }
7421 1.1 christos break;
7422 1.1 christos }
7423 1.1 christos
7424 1.10 christos /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7425 1.10 christos branch_bit = 0;
7426 1.10 christos switch (r_type)
7427 1.1 christos {
7428 1.10 christos default:
7429 1.10 christos break;
7430 1.10 christos
7431 1.1 christos /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7432 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7433 1.10 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7434 1.10 christos branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7435 1.10 christos /* Fall through. */
7436 1.10 christos
7437 1.10 christos /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7438 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7439 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7440 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7441 1.10 christos {
7442 1.7 christos unsigned int insn;
7443 1.7 christos
7444 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7445 1.10 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7446 1.10 christos insn |= branch_bit;
7447 1.10 christos
7448 1.7 christos from = (rel->r_offset
7449 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset
7450 1.10 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
7451 1.10 christos
7452 1.10 christos /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7453 1.10 christos if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7454 1.10 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7455 1.10 christos
7456 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7457 1.10 christos }
7458 1.10 christos break;
7459 1.10 christos
7460 1.10 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7461 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7462 1.10 christos {
7463 1.10 christos unsigned int insn;
7464 1.10 christos
7465 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7466 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7467 1.10 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
7468 1.7 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7469 1.1 christos {
7470 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7471 1.3 christos {
7472 1.3 christos /* Convert addis to lis. */
7473 1.3 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7474 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7475 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7476 1.3 christos }
7477 1.3 christos }
7478 1.3 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7479 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7480 1.3 christos (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7481 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7482 1.3 christos "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7483 1.10 christos }
7484 1.10 christos break;
7485 1.3 christos }
7486 1.7 christos
7487 1.3 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7488 1.9 christos && h != NULL
7489 1.3 christos && !h->def_regular
7490 1.3 christos && h->protected_def
7491 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7492 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7493 1.3 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7494 1.3 christos {
7495 1.3 christos /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7496 1.3 christos variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7497 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
7498 1.3 christos
7499 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA
7500 1.3 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7501 1.3 christos {
7502 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7503 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7504 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7505 1.7 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7506 1.3 christos {
7507 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p;
7508 1.7 christos bfd_vma off;
7509 1.3 christos bfd_vma got_addr;
7510 1.3 christos
7511 1.3 christos p = (contents + input_section->size
7512 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size
7513 1.3 christos - relax_info->picfixup_size
7514 1.7 christos + picfixup_size);
7515 1.7 christos off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7516 1.3 christos if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7517 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7518 1.3 christos (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7519 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7520 1.3 christos
7521 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7522 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7523 1.3 christos got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7524 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7525 1.3 christos + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7526 1.3 christos wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7527 1.3 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7528 1.3 christos wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7529 1.3 christos insn &= ~0xffff;
7530 1.3 christos insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7531 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7532 1.3 christos
7533 1.3 christos /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7534 1.3 christos insn &= ~0xffff;
7535 1.3 christos insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7536 1.3 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7537 1.3 christos insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7538 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7539 1.3 christos
7540 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7541 1.7 christos picfixup_size += 12;
7542 1.7 christos
7543 1.7 christos /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7544 1.7 christos output is reasonable. */
7545 1.3 christos memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7546 1.3 christos wrel++, rel++;
7547 1.10 christos rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7548 1.10 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7549 1.10 christos rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7550 1.3 christos
7551 1.7 christos /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7552 1.3 christos dynamic reloc. */
7553 1.9 christos r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7554 1.9 christos }
7555 1.9 christos else
7556 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
7557 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7558 1.9 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7559 1.9 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7560 1.9 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7561 1.9 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7562 1.9 christos }
7563 1.9 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO
7564 1.9 christos && offset_in_range (input_section,
7565 1.9 christos rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7566 1.9 christos {
7567 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7568 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7569 1.9 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7570 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7571 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7572 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7573 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7574 1.10 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7575 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7576 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7577 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7578 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7579 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7580 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7581 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7582 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7583 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7584 1.3 christos && (insn & 3) != 1)
7585 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7586 1.3 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7587 1.1 christos {
7588 1.10 christos /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7589 1.1 christos relocation = 0;
7590 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
7591 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7592 1.1 christos }
7593 1.1 christos else
7594 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
7595 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7596 1.1 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7597 1.1 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7598 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7599 1.1 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7600 1.1 christos }
7601 1.1 christos }
7602 1.1 christos
7603 1.1 christos ifunc = NULL;
7604 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
7605 1.1 christos {
7606 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
7607 1.1 christos
7608 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
7609 1.3 christos {
7610 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7611 1.7 christos ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7612 1.7 christos }
7613 1.7 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7614 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7615 1.1 christos {
7616 1.7 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7617 1.7 christos
7618 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7619 1.7 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7620 1.7 christos ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7621 1.1 christos }
7622 1.1 christos
7623 1.1 christos ent = NULL;
7624 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL
7625 1.1 christos && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7626 1.7 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7627 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7628 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7629 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7630 1.7 christos {
7631 1.7 christos addend = 0;
7632 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7633 1.7 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7634 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7635 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7636 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7637 1.7 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
7638 1.7 christos ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7639 1.7 christos }
7640 1.7 christos if (ent != NULL)
7641 1.7 christos {
7642 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7643 1.7 christos && ent->sec != got2
7644 1.7 christos && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7645 1.7 christos && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7646 1.1 christos || h == NULL
7647 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1))
7648 1.10 christos {
7649 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7650 1.1 christos for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7651 1.3 christos finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7652 1.3 christos apparently are using code compiled with
7653 1.1 christos -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7654 1.1 christos gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7655 1.1 christos whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7656 1.1 christos is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7657 1.7 christos into .got2). */
7658 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7659 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7660 1.1 christos (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7661 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7662 1.1 christos }
7663 1.1 christos
7664 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
7665 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7666 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7667 1.1 christos || h == NULL
7668 1.7 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
7669 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7670 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
7671 1.1 christos + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7672 1.1 christos else
7673 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7674 1.10 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7675 1.10 christos + ent->plt.offset);
7676 1.10 christos }
7677 1.10 christos }
7678 1.10 christos
7679 1.10 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
7680 1.10 christos save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7681 1.10 christos howto = NULL;
7682 1.1 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7683 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7684 1.10 christos
7685 1.3 christos tls_type = 0;
7686 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
7687 1.1 christos {
7688 1.1 christos default:
7689 1.1 christos de_fault:
7690 1.1 christos if (howto)
7691 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7692 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7693 1.1 christos input_bfd, howto->name);
7694 1.3 christos else
7695 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7696 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: reloc %#x unsupported"),
7697 1.1 christos input_bfd, r_type);
7698 1.1 christos
7699 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7700 1.1 christos ret = false;
7701 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7702 1.1 christos
7703 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE:
7704 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
7705 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7706 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7707 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7708 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7709 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7710 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7711 1.1 christos
7712 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7713 1.1 christos address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7714 1.1 christos symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7715 1.1 christos symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7716 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7717 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7718 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7719 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7720 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7721 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7722 1.1 christos
7723 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7724 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7725 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7726 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7727 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7728 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7729 1.1 christos
7730 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7731 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7732 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7733 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7734 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7735 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7736 1.1 christos
7737 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7738 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7739 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7740 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7741 1.7 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7742 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7743 1.1 christos
7744 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
7745 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7746 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7747 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7748 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0;
7749 1.1 christos dogot:
7750 1.7 christos {
7751 1.7 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7752 1.7 christos offset table. */
7753 1.7 christos bfd_vma off;
7754 1.1 christos bfd_vma *offp;
7755 1.1 christos unsigned long indx;
7756 1.1 christos
7757 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7758 1.1 christos abort ();
7759 1.1 christos
7760 1.1 christos indx = 0;
7761 1.1 christos if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7762 1.10 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7763 1.1 christos offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7764 1.1 christos else if (h != NULL)
7765 1.1 christos {
7766 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7767 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1
7768 1.1 christos || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7769 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7770 1.1 christos /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7771 1.1 christos -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7772 1.1 christos locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7773 1.1 christos because of a version file. */
7774 1.1 christos ;
7775 1.1 christos else
7776 1.1 christos {
7777 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx;
7778 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
7779 1.1 christos }
7780 1.1 christos offp = &h->got.offset;
7781 1.7 christos }
7782 1.7 christos else
7783 1.9 christos {
7784 1.7 christos if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7785 1.1 christos abort ();
7786 1.1 christos offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7787 1.1 christos }
7788 1.9 christos
7789 1.9 christos /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7790 1.1 christos least significant bit to record whether we have already
7791 1.1 christos processed this entry. */
7792 1.1 christos off = *offp;
7793 1.1 christos if ((off & 1) != 0)
7794 1.1 christos off &= ~1;
7795 1.1 christos else
7796 1.1 christos {
7797 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7798 1.1 christos ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7799 1.1 christos | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7800 1.1 christos : 0);
7801 1.1 christos
7802 1.1 christos if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7803 1.1 christos tls_m = TLS_LD;
7804 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7805 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7806 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7807 1.1 christos
7808 1.1 christos /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7809 1.1 christos Initialize them all. */
7810 1.1 christos do
7811 1.1 christos {
7812 1.1 christos int tls_ty = 0;
7813 1.9 christos
7814 1.1 christos if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7815 1.1 christos {
7816 1.1 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7817 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7818 1.1 christos }
7819 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7820 1.7 christos {
7821 1.7 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7822 1.7 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7823 1.9 christos }
7824 1.9 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7825 1.7 christos {
7826 1.10 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7827 1.10 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7828 1.10 christos }
7829 1.10 christos else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7830 1.1 christos {
7831 1.7 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7832 1.1 christos tls_m = 0;
7833 1.3 christos }
7834 1.7 christos
7835 1.7 christos /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7836 1.7 christos if (indx != 0
7837 1.7 christos || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7838 1.7 christos && (h == NULL
7839 1.7 christos || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7840 1.7 christos && !(tls_ty != 0
7841 1.7 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)
7842 1.7 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7843 1.1 christos && (h != NULL
7844 1.1 christos ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
7845 1.1 christos : sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)))
7846 1.1 christos {
7847 1.1 christos asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7848 1.1 christos
7849 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
7850 1.11 christos {
7851 1.11 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7852 1.11 christos if (indx == 0)
7853 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7854 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h))
7855 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7856 1.1 christos }
7857 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7858 1.1 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7859 1.1 christos + off);
7860 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0;
7861 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7862 1.1 christos {
7863 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7864 1.1 christos if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7865 1.1 christos {
7866 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd,
7867 1.1 christos &outrel,
7868 1.1 christos rsec));
7869 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset += 4;
7870 1.1 christos outrel.r_info
7871 1.1 christos = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7872 1.3 christos }
7873 1.3 christos }
7874 1.3 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7875 1.3 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7876 1.3 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7877 1.3 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7878 1.1 christos else if (indx != 0)
7879 1.11 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7880 1.11 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
7881 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7882 1.1 christos else
7883 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7884 1.1 christos if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7885 1.1 christos {
7886 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7887 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7888 1.1 christos {
7889 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7890 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0;
7891 1.3 christos else
7892 1.3 christos outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7893 1.3 christos }
7894 1.3 christos }
7895 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd,
7896 1.7 christos &outrel, rsec));
7897 1.7 christos }
7898 1.7 christos
7899 1.7 christos /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7900 1.3 christos emitting a reloc. */
7901 1.3 christos else
7902 1.1 christos {
7903 1.7 christos bfd_vma value = relocation;
7904 1.1 christos
7905 1.7 christos if (tls_ty != 0)
7906 1.7 christos {
7907 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7908 1.1 christos value = 0;
7909 1.1 christos else
7910 1.7 christos {
7911 1.7 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7912 1.1 christos value = 0;
7913 1.1 christos else
7914 1.1 christos value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7915 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7916 1.1 christos value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7917 1.1 christos }
7918 1.1 christos
7919 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7920 1.1 christos {
7921 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7922 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7923 1.1 christos value = 1;
7924 1.1 christos }
7925 1.1 christos }
7926 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7927 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7928 1.1 christos }
7929 1.1 christos
7930 1.1 christos off += 4;
7931 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7932 1.9 christos off += 4;
7933 1.1 christos }
7934 1.1 christos while (tls_m != 0);
7935 1.1 christos
7936 1.1 christos off = *offp;
7937 1.1 christos *offp = off | 1;
7938 1.1 christos }
7939 1.1 christos
7940 1.1 christos if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7941 1.1 christos abort ();
7942 1.1 christos
7943 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7944 1.1 christos {
7945 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7946 1.1 christos {
7947 1.3 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7948 1.3 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7949 1.3 christos off += 8;
7950 1.3 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7951 1.7 christos {
7952 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7953 1.1 christos off += 8;
7954 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7955 1.1 christos {
7956 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7957 1.1 christos off += 4;
7958 1.1 christos }
7959 1.1 christos }
7960 1.1 christos }
7961 1.1 christos }
7962 1.7 christos
7963 1.7 christos /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7964 1.1 christos if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7965 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7966 1.1 christos
7967 1.1 christos relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7968 1.3 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7969 1.1 christos + off
7970 1.3 christos - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7971 1.1 christos
7972 1.1 christos /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7973 1.1 christos x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7974 1.1 christos generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7975 1.1 christos got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7976 1.6 christos if (addend != 0)
7977 1.6 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7978 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7979 1.6 christos (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7980 1.6 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7981 1.10 christos howto->name,
7982 1.3 christos sym_name);
7983 1.1 christos }
7984 1.7 christos break;
7985 1.7 christos
7986 1.7 christos /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7987 1.7 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7988 1.7 christos /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7989 1.7 christos at a symbol not in this object. */
7990 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
7991 1.7 christos {
7992 1.7 christos (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7993 1.7 christos h->root.root.string,
7994 1.7 christos input_bfd,
7995 1.7 christos input_section,
7996 1.7 christos rel->r_offset,
7997 1.7 christos true);
7998 1.7 christos goto copy_reloc;
7999 1.1 christos }
8000 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
8001 1.1 christos {
8002 1.1 christos /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
8003 1.1 christos the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
8004 1.1 christos seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
8005 1.3 christos stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
8006 1.3 christos access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
8007 1.1 christos local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
8008 1.1 christos -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
8009 1.1 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
8010 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8011 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
8012 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8013 1.1 christos h->root.root.string);
8014 1.1 christos }
8015 1.1 christos break;
8016 1.1 christos
8017 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8018 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8019 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8020 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8021 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8022 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8023 1.1 christos break;
8024 1.1 christos
8025 1.7 christos /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8026 1.1 christos object. */
8027 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8028 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8029 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8030 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8031 1.3 christos if (h != NULL
8032 1.3 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8033 1.1 christos && h->dynindx == -1
8034 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
8035 1.7 christos {
8036 1.1 christos /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8037 1.1 christos resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8038 1.1 christos code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8039 1.3 christos defined before using them. */
8040 1.3 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8041 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8042 1.1 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8043 1.1 christos if (insn != 0)
8044 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8045 1.3 christos break;
8046 1.1 christos }
8047 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8048 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8049 1.1 christos /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8050 1.1 christos libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8051 1.1 christos DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8052 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8053 1.1 christos
8054 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8055 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8056 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8057 1.3 christos goto dodyn;
8058 1.1 christos
8059 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8060 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8061 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8062 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8063 1.1 christos
8064 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8065 1.1 christos relocation = 1;
8066 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8067 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8068 1.1 christos
8069 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
8070 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8071 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8072 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8073 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8074 1.1 christos break;
8075 1.1 christos
8076 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
8077 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8078 1.1 christos break;
8079 1.1 christos /* fall through */
8080 1.1 christos
8081 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8082 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8083 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8084 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8085 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8086 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8087 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8088 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8089 1.1 christos
8090 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8091 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8092 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8093 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
8094 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
8095 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8096 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8097 1.1 christos /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8098 1.1 christos handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8099 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8100 1.1 christos || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8101 1.7 christos break;
8102 1.7 christos /* fall through */
8103 1.10 christos
8104 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8105 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8106 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8107 1.10 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8108 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8109 1.1 christos break;
8110 1.3 christos /* fall through */
8111 1.7 christos
8112 1.7 christos dodyn:
8113 1.1 christos if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8114 1.1 christos || is_vxworks_tls)
8115 1.1 christos break;
8116 1.1 christos
8117 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8118 1.1 christos ? ((h == NULL
8119 1.1 christos || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8120 1.1 christos && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8121 1.1 christos || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8122 1.1 christos : (h != NULL
8123 1.1 christos && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8124 1.1 christos {
8125 1.1 christos int skip;
8126 1.1 christos asection *sreloc;
8127 1.1 christos long indx = 0;
8128 1.1 christos
8129 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
8130 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8131 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n",
8132 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string
8133 1.9 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8134 1.9 christos #endif
8135 1.9 christos
8136 1.9 christos /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8137 1.9 christos are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8138 1.9 christos time. */
8139 1.9 christos skip = 0;
8140 1.9 christos outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8141 1.1 christos input_section,
8142 1.1 christos rel->r_offset);
8143 1.7 christos if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8144 1.1 christos || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8145 1.7 christos skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8146 1.7 christos outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8147 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset);
8148 1.7 christos
8149 1.1 christos /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8150 1.1 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8151 1.1 christos || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8152 1.1 christos r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8153 1.1 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8154 1.1 christos || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8155 1.1 christos r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8156 1.1 christos
8157 1.1 christos if (skip)
8158 1.1 christos memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8159 1.1 christos else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8160 1.1 christos {
8161 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx;
8162 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8163 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
8164 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8165 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8166 1.1 christos }
8167 1.1 christos else
8168 1.1 christos {
8169 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8170 1.1 christos
8171 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8172 1.7 christos {
8173 1.7 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
8174 1.1 christos {
8175 1.1 christos /* If we get here when building a static
8176 1.1 christos executable, then the libc startup function
8177 1.1 christos responsible for applying indirect function
8178 1.10 christos relocations is going to complain about
8179 1.1 christos the reloc type.
8180 1.1 christos If we get here when building a dynamic
8181 1.1 christos executable, it will be because we have
8182 1.1 christos a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8183 1.1 christos will set the text segment writable and
8184 1.1 christos non-executable to apply text relocations.
8185 1.10 christos So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8186 1.1 christos indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8187 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8188 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8189 1.1 christos (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8190 1.1 christos "function %s unsupported\n"),
8191 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8192 1.1 christos howto->name,
8193 1.1 christos sym_name);
8194 1.1 christos ret = false;
8195 1.1 christos }
8196 1.1 christos else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8197 1.1 christos ;
8198 1.9 christos else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8199 1.9 christos {
8200 1.9 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8201 1.9 christos ret = false;
8202 1.9 christos }
8203 1.9 christos else
8204 1.1 christos {
8205 1.1 christos asection *osec;
8206 1.9 christos
8207 1.9 christos /* We are turning this relocation into one
8208 1.9 christos against a section symbol. It would be
8209 1.9 christos proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8210 1.9 christos osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8211 1.9 christos but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8212 1.1 christos FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8213 1.9 christos osec = sec->output_section;
8214 1.9 christos if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8215 1.9 christos {
8216 1.9 christos osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8217 1.9 christos indx = 0;
8218 1.9 christos }
8219 1.1 christos else
8220 1.1 christos {
8221 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8222 1.1 christos if (indx == 0)
8223 1.1 christos {
8224 1.1 christos osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8225 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8226 1.1 christos }
8227 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8228 1.1 christos }
8229 1.7 christos
8230 1.7 christos /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8231 1.7 christos Don't leave the symbol value in the
8232 1.7 christos addend for them. */
8233 1.7 christos if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8234 1.7 christos outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8235 1.7 christos }
8236 1.7 christos
8237 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8238 1.7 christos }
8239 1.10 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
8240 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8241 1.11 christos else
8242 1.11 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8243 1.1 christos }
8244 1.1 christos
8245 1.3 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8246 1.1 christos if (ifunc)
8247 1.7 christos {
8248 1.7 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8249 1.7 christos if (indx == 0)
8250 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8251 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h))
8252 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8253 1.1 christos }
8254 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
8255 1.1 christos return false;
8256 1.1 christos
8257 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
8258 1.1 christos sreloc));
8259 1.1 christos
8260 1.1 christos if (skip == -1)
8261 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8262 1.1 christos
8263 1.1 christos /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8264 1.1 christos so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8265 1.1 christos if (!skip)
8266 1.1 christos {
8267 1.3 christos relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8268 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8269 1.1 christos break;
8270 1.1 christos }
8271 1.1 christos }
8272 1.1 christos break;
8273 1.1 christos
8274 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8275 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8276 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
8277 1.7 christos {
8278 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8279 1.1 christos bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8280 1.1 christos
8281 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8282 1.1 christos {
8283 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8284 1.10 christos got2_addend = addend;
8285 1.10 christos addend = 0;
8286 1.10 christos }
8287 1.10 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8288 1.10 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8289 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8290 1.10 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
8291 1.10 christos + ent->glink_offset);
8292 1.10 christos else
8293 1.10 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8294 1.3 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8295 1.10 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8296 1.10 christos }
8297 1.10 christos /* Fall through. */
8298 1.10 christos
8299 1.10 christos case R_PPC_RELAX:
8300 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8301 1.10 christos ? offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - 12,
8302 1.10 christos ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) * 4)
8303 1.10 christos : offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset,
8304 1.10 christos ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry) * 4))
8305 1.10 christos {
8306 1.10 christos const int *stub;
8307 1.10 christos size_t size;
8308 1.10 christos size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8309 1.10 christos unsigned int insn;
8310 1.10 christos
8311 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8312 1.1 christos {
8313 1.10 christos relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8314 1.10 christos + input_section->output_offset
8315 1.10 christos + rel->r_offset - 4);
8316 1.3 christos stub = shared_stub_entry;
8317 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8318 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8319 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8320 1.10 christos stub += 3;
8321 1.10 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8322 1.10 christos }
8323 1.10 christos else
8324 1.10 christos {
8325 1.10 christos stub = stub_entry;
8326 1.10 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8327 1.10 christos }
8328 1.10 christos
8329 1.10 christos relocation += addend;
8330 1.10 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8331 1.10 christos relocation = 0;
8332 1.10 christos
8333 1.10 christos /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8334 1.10 christos insn = *stub++;
8335 1.10 christos insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8336 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8337 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4;
8338 1.10 christos
8339 1.10 christos insn = *stub++;
8340 1.10 christos insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8341 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8342 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4;
8343 1.10 christos size -= 2;
8344 1.10 christos
8345 1.10 christos while (size != 0)
8346 1.10 christos {
8347 1.10 christos insn = *stub++;
8348 1.10 christos --size;
8349 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8350 1.10 christos insn_offset += 4;
8351 1.1 christos }
8352 1.1 christos
8353 1.1 christos /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8354 1.1 christos relocs to describe this relocation. */
8355 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8356 1.1 christos /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8357 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8358 1.10 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8359 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8360 1.1 christos memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8361 1.1 christos wrel++, rel++;
8362 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset += 4;
8363 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8364 1.1 christos }
8365 1.1 christos else
8366 1.1 christos goto de_fault;
8367 1.1 christos continue;
8368 1.1 christos
8369 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8370 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8371 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8372 1.10 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8373 1.1 christos {
8374 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8375 1.1 christos break;
8376 1.1 christos }
8377 1.1 christos relocation
8378 1.1 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8379 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel);
8380 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8381 1.1 christos break;
8382 1.1 christos
8383 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8384 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8385 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8386 1.1 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8387 1.1 christos {
8388 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8389 1.1 christos break;
8390 1.1 christos }
8391 1.9 christos relocation
8392 1.9 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8393 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel);
8394 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8395 1.1 christos break;
8396 1.1 christos
8397 1.1 christos /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8398 1.1 christos section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8399 1.1 christos an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8400 1.3 christos AIX .toc section. */
8401 1.3 christos case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8402 1.3 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8403 1.3 christos {
8404 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8405 1.7 christos break;
8406 1.1 christos }
8407 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8408 1.1 christos || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8409 1.1 christos
8410 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8411 1.1 christos break;
8412 1.1 christos
8413 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8414 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8415 1.10 christos {
8416 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8417 1.1 christos
8418 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8419 1.1 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8420 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL
8421 1.7 christos || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8422 1.7 christos {
8423 1.1 christos /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8424 1.1 christos happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8425 1.1 christos using -Bsymbolic. */
8426 1.1 christos }
8427 1.1 christos else
8428 1.1 christos {
8429 1.1 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8430 1.1 christos procedure linkage table. */
8431 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
8432 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8433 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8434 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
8435 1.7 christos + ent->glink_offset);
8436 1.7 christos else
8437 1.7 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8438 1.7 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8439 1.7 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8440 1.7 christos }
8441 1.7 christos }
8442 1.7 christos
8443 1.7 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8444 1.7 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8445 1.7 christos Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8446 1.7 christos addend = 0;
8447 1.7 christos break;
8448 1.7 christos
8449 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8450 1.10 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8451 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8452 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8453 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8454 1.7 christos plt_list = NULL;
8455 1.7 christos if (h != NULL)
8456 1.7 christos plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8457 1.7 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
8458 1.7 christos plt_list = ifunc;
8459 1.7 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8460 1.7 christos {
8461 1.10 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8462 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8463 1.10 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8464 1.7 christos plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8465 1.7 christos }
8466 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8467 1.7 christos if (plt_list != NULL)
8468 1.7 christos {
8469 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8470 1.7 christos
8471 1.7 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8472 1.7 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8473 1.7 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8474 1.7 christos {
8475 1.7 christos asection *plt;
8476 1.7 christos
8477 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
8478 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.splt;
8479 1.7 christos if (use_local_plt (info, h))
8480 1.7 christos {
8481 1.7 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
8482 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8483 1.7 christos else
8484 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
8485 1.7 christos }
8486 1.7 christos relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8487 1.7 christos + plt->output_offset
8488 1.7 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8489 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8490 1.1 christos {
8491 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0;
8492 1.1 christos
8493 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8494 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend
8495 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8496 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset);
8497 1.1 christos else
8498 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8499 1.1 christos relocation -= got;
8500 1.10 christos }
8501 1.1 christos }
8502 1.1 christos }
8503 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8504 1.1 christos break;
8505 1.9 christos
8506 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8507 1.3 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8508 1.1 christos {
8509 1.7 christos const char *name;
8510 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8511 1.7 christos
8512 1.7 christos if (sec == NULL
8513 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL
8514 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda))
8515 1.1 christos {
8516 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8517 1.1 christos break;
8518 1.1 christos }
8519 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8520 1.1 christos
8521 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8522 1.1 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8523 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8524 1.1 christos {
8525 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
8526 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8527 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8528 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8529 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8530 1.1 christos sym_name,
8531 1.10 christos howto->name,
8532 1.1 christos name);
8533 1.1 christos }
8534 1.1 christos }
8535 1.1 christos break;
8536 1.9 christos
8537 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8538 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8539 1.1 christos {
8540 1.7 christos const char *name;
8541 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8542 1.7 christos
8543 1.7 christos if (sec == NULL
8544 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL
8545 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda))
8546 1.1 christos {
8547 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8548 1.1 christos break;
8549 1.1 christos }
8550 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8551 1.1 christos
8552 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8553 1.3 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8554 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8555 1.10 christos {
8556 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler
8557 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8558 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8559 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8560 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8561 1.3 christos sym_name,
8562 1.10 christos howto->name,
8563 1.10 christos name);
8564 1.10 christos }
8565 1.10 christos }
8566 1.10 christos break;
8567 1.1 christos
8568 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8569 1.3 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8570 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8571 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8572 1.10 christos split16a_type,
8573 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8574 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8575 1.1 christos
8576 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8577 1.3 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8578 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8579 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8580 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8581 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8582 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8583 1.1 christos
8584 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8585 1.3 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8586 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8587 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8588 1.10 christos split16a_type,
8589 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8590 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8591 1.1 christos
8592 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8593 1.3 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8594 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8595 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8596 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8597 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8598 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8599 1.1 christos
8600 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8601 1.1 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8602 1.1 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8603 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8604 1.1 christos split16a_type,
8605 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8606 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8607 1.10 christos
8608 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8609 1.10 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8610 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8611 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8612 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8613 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8614 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8615 1.10 christos
8616 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8617 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8618 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8619 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8620 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8621 1.10 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8622 1.1 christos {
8623 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8624 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8625 1.10 christos }
8626 1.10 christos else
8627 1.10 christos {
8628 1.10 christos const char *name;
8629 1.10 christos int reg;
8630 1.10 christos unsigned int insn;
8631 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8632 1.10 christos
8633 1.10 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8634 1.10 christos {
8635 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8636 1.10 christos break;
8637 1.10 christos }
8638 1.10 christos
8639 1.10 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8640 1.10 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8641 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8642 1.10 christos {
8643 1.10 christos reg = 13;
8644 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8645 1.10 christos }
8646 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8647 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8648 1.10 christos {
8649 1.10 christos reg = 2;
8650 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8651 1.10 christos }
8652 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8653 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8654 1.10 christos {
8655 1.10 christos reg = 0;
8656 1.1 christos }
8657 1.10 christos else
8658 1.10 christos {
8659 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler
8660 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8661 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8662 1.10 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8663 1.10 christos input_bfd,
8664 1.10 christos sym_name,
8665 1.10 christos howto->name,
8666 1.1 christos name);
8667 1.10 christos
8668 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8669 1.1 christos ret = false;
8670 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc;
8671 1.10 christos }
8672 1.10 christos
8673 1.10 christos if (sda != NULL)
8674 1.10 christos {
8675 1.10 christos if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8676 1.10 christos {
8677 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8678 1.10 christos break;
8679 1.9 christos }
8680 1.10 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8681 1.10 christos }
8682 1.10 christos
8683 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8684 1.10 christos break;
8685 1.10 christos
8686 1.10 christos /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8687 1.3 christos version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8688 1.10 christos operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8689 1.10 christos GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8690 1.10 christos a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8691 1.10 christos producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8692 1.10 christos generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8693 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8694 1.10 christos rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8695 1.10 christos
8696 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8697 1.10 christos if (reg == 0
8698 1.10 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8699 1.10 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8700 1.10 christos {
8701 1.10 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8702 1.10 christos addend = 0;
8703 1.10 christos
8704 1.10 christos /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8705 1.10 christos insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8706 1.10 christos insn |= 28u << 26;
8707 1.10 christos
8708 1.10 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8709 1.10 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8710 1.10 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8711 1.10 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8712 1.1 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8713 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8714 1.1 christos insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8715 1.1 christos
8716 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8717 1.1 christos
8718 1.1 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8719 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8720 1.10 christos && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8721 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
8722 1.10 christos goto report_reloc;
8723 1.10 christos }
8724 1.10 christos /* Fill in register field. */
8725 1.10 christos insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8726 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8727 1.1 christos }
8728 1.10 christos break;
8729 1.10 christos
8730 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8731 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8732 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8733 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8734 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8735 1.10 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8736 1.10 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8737 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8738 1.10 christos else
8739 1.10 christos {
8740 1.10 christos bfd_vma value;
8741 1.10 christos const char *name;
8742 1.10 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8743 1.10 christos
8744 1.10 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8745 1.10 christos {
8746 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8747 1.10 christos break;
8748 1.10 christos }
8749 1.10 christos
8750 1.10 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8751 1.10 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8752 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8753 1.10 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8754 1.10 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8755 1.10 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8756 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8757 1.10 christos else
8758 1.10 christos {
8759 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler
8760 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8761 1.10 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8762 1.10 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8763 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8764 1.10 christos sym_name,
8765 1.10 christos howto->name,
8766 1.10 christos name);
8767 1.10 christos
8768 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8769 1.10 christos ret = false;
8770 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc;
8771 1.10 christos }
8772 1.10 christos
8773 1.10 christos if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8774 1.10 christos {
8775 1.10 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8776 1.10 christos break;
8777 1.10 christos }
8778 1.10 christos value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8779 1.10 christos
8780 1.10 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8781 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8782 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8783 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8784 1.10 christos split16a_type,
8785 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8786 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8787 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8788 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8789 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8790 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8791 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8792 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8793 1.10 christos {
8794 1.10 christos value = value >> 16;
8795 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8796 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8797 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8798 1.10 christos split16a_type,
8799 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8800 1.10 christos }
8801 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8802 1.10 christos {
8803 1.10 christos value = value >> 16;
8804 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8805 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8806 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8807 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8808 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8809 1.10 christos }
8810 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8811 1.10 christos {
8812 1.10 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8813 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8814 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8815 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8816 1.1 christos split16a_type,
8817 1.7 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8818 1.10 christos }
8819 1.10 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8820 1.10 christos {
8821 1.10 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8822 1.10 christos r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8823 1.10 christos rel->r_offset,
8824 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8825 1.10 christos split16d_type,
8826 1.10 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8827 1.7 christos }
8828 1.1 christos else
8829 1.1 christos abort ();
8830 1.1 christos }
8831 1.1 christos goto report_reloc;
8832 1.1 christos
8833 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8834 1.1 christos if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8835 1.10 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8836 1.1 christos else
8837 1.1 christos {
8838 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset,
8839 1.1 christos relocation);
8840 1.1 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8841 1.1 christos }
8842 1.1 christos goto report_reloc;
8843 1.1 christos
8844 1.1 christos /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8845 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8846 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8847 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8848 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8849 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8850 1.1 christos {
8851 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = true;
8852 1.1 christos break;
8853 1.1 christos }
8854 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8855 1.1 christos break;
8856 1.1 christos
8857 1.1 christos /* Negative relocations. */
8858 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8859 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8860 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8861 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8862 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8863 1.7 christos addend -= 2 * relocation;
8864 1.7 christos break;
8865 1.7 christos
8866 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
8867 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8868 1.10 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8869 1.3 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8870 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8871 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32:
8872 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8873 1.7 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8874 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8875 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8876 1.7 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8877 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8878 1.10 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8879 1.10 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8880 1.10 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8881 1.10 christos input_bfd, howto->name);
8882 1.10 christos
8883 1.10 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8884 1.10 christos ret = false;
8885 1.10 christos goto copy_reloc;
8886 1.10 christos }
8887 1.10 christos
8888 1.10 christos switch (r_type)
8889 1.10 christos {
8890 1.10 christos default:
8891 1.10 christos break;
8892 1.10 christos
8893 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8894 1.10 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt
8895 1.10 christos && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
8896 1.10 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8897 1.10 christos
8898 1.10 christos {
8899 1.10 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8900 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8901 1.10 christos }
8902 1.10 christos break;
8903 1.10 christos
8904 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8905 1.10 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt
8906 1.10 christos && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
8907 1.7 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8908 1.7 christos {
8909 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8910 1.10 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8911 1.10 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
8912 1.10 christos insn |= 2 << 16;
8913 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8914 1.10 christos }
8915 1.10 christos break;
8916 1.10 christos }
8917 1.10 christos
8918 1.10 christos switch (r_type)
8919 1.10 christos {
8920 1.7 christos default:
8921 1.7 christos break;
8922 1.7 christos
8923 1.9 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8924 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8925 1.7 christos {
8926 1.7 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8927 1.7 christos {
8928 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8929 1.7 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8930 1.7 christos insn &= 1;
8931 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8932 1.7 christos unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8933 1.10 christos r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8934 1.10 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8935 1.10 christos }
8936 1.10 christos }
8937 1.10 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8938 1.10 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8939 1.10 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8940 1.10 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8941 1.7 christos howto->name);
8942 1.7 christos break;
8943 1.7 christos
8944 1.9 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8945 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8946 1.7 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8947 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8948 1.7 christos {
8949 1.7 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8950 1.1 christos {
8951 1.1 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8952 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8953 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = false;
8954 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8955 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8956 1.1 christos }
8957 1.1 christos }
8958 1.3 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8959 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8960 1.1 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8961 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8962 1.1 christos howto->name);
8963 1.1 christos break;
8964 1.1 christos }
8965 1.1 christos
8966 1.1 christos /* Do any further special processing. */
8967 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
8968 1.1 christos {
8969 1.1 christos default:
8970 1.7 christos break;
8971 1.1 christos
8972 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8973 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8974 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8975 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8976 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8977 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8978 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8979 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8980 1.1 christos /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8981 1.1 christos that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8982 1.1 christos 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8983 1.1 christos alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8984 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL)
8985 1.1 christos break;
8986 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
8987 1.1 christos
8988 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8989 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8990 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8991 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8992 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8993 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8994 1.1 christos /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8995 1.1 christos Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8996 1.1 christos addend += 0x8000;
8997 1.1 christos break;
8998 1.1 christos
8999 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
9000 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
9001 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
9002 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
9003 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
9004 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
9005 1.10 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
9006 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
9007 1.10 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
9008 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
9009 1.10 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
9010 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
9011 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
9012 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
9013 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
9014 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
9015 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
9016 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
9017 1.10 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
9018 1.10 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
9019 1.10 christos {
9020 1.10 christos /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
9021 1.10 christos certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
9022 1.10 christos that make up part of the insn opcode. */
9023 1.10 christos unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
9024 1.10 christos
9025 1.10 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
9026 1.10 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
9027 1.10 christos mask = 0;
9028 1.10 christos if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
9029 1.10 christos mask = 3;
9030 1.10 christos else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
9031 1.10 christos mask = 15;
9032 1.10 christos else
9033 1.1 christos break;
9034 1.1 christos relocation += addend;
9035 1.1 christos addend = insn & mask;
9036 1.1 christos lobit = mask & relocation;
9037 1.1 christos if (lobit != 0)
9038 1.1 christos {
9039 1.1 christos relocation ^= lobit;
9040 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9041 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9042 1.1 christos (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
9043 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9044 1.1 christos howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
9045 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9046 1.1 christos ret = false;
9047 1.1 christos }
9048 1.1 christos }
9049 1.1 christos break;
9050 1.1 christos }
9051 1.1 christos
9052 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9053 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
9054 1.7 christos "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
9055 1.7 christos howto->name,
9056 1.1 christos (int) r_type,
9057 1.1 christos sym_name,
9058 1.1 christos r_symndx,
9059 1.10 christos (long) rel->r_offset,
9060 1.1 christos (long) addend);
9061 1.1 christos #endif
9062 1.3 christos
9063 1.3 christos if (unresolved_reloc
9064 1.3 christos && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
9065 1.3 christos && h->def_dynamic)
9066 1.3 christos && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
9067 1.10 christos rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
9068 1.10 christos {
9069 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9070 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9071 1.3 christos (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
9072 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9073 1.3 christos howto->name,
9074 1.3 christos sym_name);
9075 1.3 christos ret = false;
9076 1.3 christos }
9077 1.9 christos
9078 1.3 christos /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9079 1.9 christos few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
9080 1.9 christos have different reloc types. */
9081 1.9 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9082 1.3 christos && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9083 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
9084 1.3 christos && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9085 1.3 christos {
9086 1.3 christos enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9087 1.3 christos
9088 1.3 christos if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9089 1.3 christos {
9090 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9091 1.3 christos
9092 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9093 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9094 1.3 christos complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9095 1.10 christos else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9096 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9097 1.3 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9098 1.3 christos complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9099 1.3 christos }
9100 1.3 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9101 1.3 christos {
9102 1.3 christos alt_howto = *howto;
9103 1.3 christos alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9104 1.3 christos howto = &alt_howto;
9105 1.3 christos }
9106 1.3 christos }
9107 1.3 christos
9108 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9109 1.3 christos {
9110 1.3 christos /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9111 1.3 christos if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
9112 1.3 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9113 1.3 christos else
9114 1.3 christos {
9115 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9116 1.1 christos
9117 1.10 christos relocation += addend;
9118 1.1 christos relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9119 1.1 christos + input_section->output_offset
9120 1.1 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
9121 1.1 christos relocation >>= 16;
9122 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9123 1.3 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9124 1.3 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9125 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9126 1.3 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9127 1.3 christos }
9128 1.3 christos }
9129 1.6 christos else
9130 1.6 christos r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9131 1.6 christos rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9132 1.1 christos
9133 1.1 christos report_reloc:
9134 1.1 christos if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9135 1.1 christos {
9136 1.7 christos if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9137 1.7 christos {
9138 1.1 christos /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9139 1.1 christos on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9140 1.10 christos if (!warned
9141 1.1 christos && !(h != NULL
9142 1.1 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9143 1.3 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9144 1.3 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9145 1.3 christos info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9146 1.3 christos (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9147 1.3 christos rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9148 1.3 christos }
9149 1.3 christos else
9150 1.3 christos {
9151 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9152 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9153 1.3 christos (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9154 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9155 1.3 christos howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9156 1.3 christos ret = false;
9157 1.3 christos }
9158 1.3 christos }
9159 1.3 christos copy_reloc:
9160 1.3 christos if (wrel != rel)
9161 1.3 christos *wrel = *rel;
9162 1.3 christos }
9163 1.3 christos
9164 1.3 christos if (wrel != rel)
9165 1.3 christos {
9166 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9167 1.3 christos size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9168 1.1 christos
9169 1.1 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9170 1.1 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9171 1.1 christos if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9172 1.1 christos {
9173 1.1 christos /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9174 1.3 christos one NONE reloc.
9175 1.3 christos ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9176 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9177 1.3 christos deleted -= 1;
9178 1.3 christos wrel++;
9179 1.3 christos }
9180 1.3 christos relend = wrel;
9181 1.3 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9182 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9183 1.3 christos input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9184 1.3 christos }
9185 1.3 christos
9186 1.3 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9187 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9188 1.3 christos #endif
9189 1.3 christos
9190 1.3 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9191 1.3 christos && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9192 1.3 christos && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9193 1.3 christos || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9194 1.3 christos {
9195 1.3 christos /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9196 1.3 christos unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9197 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9198 1.3 christos }
9199 1.3 christos
9200 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9201 1.3 christos && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9202 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9203 1.3 christos || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9204 1.3 christos >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9205 1.3 christos {
9206 1.3 christos bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9207 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9208 1.3 christos
9209 1.3 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9210 1.3 christos {
9211 1.3 christos bfd_byte *p;
9212 1.3 christos unsigned int n;
9213 1.3 christos bfd_byte fill[4];
9214 1.3 christos
9215 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9216 1.3 christos p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9217 1.3 christos n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9218 1.3 christos while (n--)
9219 1.3 christos {
9220 1.3 christos memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9221 1.3 christos p += 4;
9222 1.3 christos }
9223 1.3 christos }
9224 1.3 christos
9225 1.10 christos /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9226 1.3 christos branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9227 1.3 christos branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9228 1.3 christos needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9229 1.3 christos wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9230 1.3 christos
9231 1.10 christos start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9232 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset);
9233 1.3 christos end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9234 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size);
9235 1.3 christos for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9236 1.3 christos addr < end_addr;
9237 1.3 christos addr += pagesize)
9238 1.3 christos {
9239 1.3 christos bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9240 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9241 1.3 christos bool is_data;
9242 1.3 christos bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9243 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9244 1.3 christos
9245 1.3 christos /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9246 1.3 christos the word alone. */
9247 1.3 christos is_data = false;
9248 1.3 christos lo = relocs;
9249 1.3 christos hi = relend;
9250 1.10 christos rel = NULL;
9251 1.3 christos while (lo < hi)
9252 1.3 christos {
9253 1.3 christos rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9254 1.3 christos if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9255 1.3 christos lo = rel + 1;
9256 1.3 christos else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9257 1.3 christos hi = rel;
9258 1.3 christos else
9259 1.3 christos {
9260 1.3 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9261 1.3 christos {
9262 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9263 1.3 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9264 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
9265 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9266 1.3 christos is_data = true;
9267 1.3 christos break;
9268 1.3 christos default:
9269 1.3 christos break;
9270 1.3 christos }
9271 1.3 christos break;
9272 1.3 christos }
9273 1.3 christos }
9274 1.3 christos if (is_data)
9275 1.3 christos continue;
9276 1.3 christos
9277 1.3 christos /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9278 1.3 christos branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9279 1.3 christos avoid the icache failure.
9280 1.3 christos
9281 1.3 christos The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9282 1.3 christos where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9283 1.3 christos page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9284 1.3 christos instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9285 1.3 christos unconditional branches:
9286 1.3 christos 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9287 1.3 christos 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9288 1.3 christos 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9289 1.3 christos where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9290 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9291 1.3 christos affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9292 1.3 christos instruction is not executed.
9293 1.3 christos
9294 1.3 christos A bctr example:
9295 1.3 christos .
9296 1.3 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha
9297 1.3 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9298 1.3 christos . mtctr 9
9299 1.3 christos . bctr
9300 1.3 christos . nop
9301 1.3 christos . nop
9302 1.3 christos . new_page:
9303 1.3 christos .
9304 1.3 christos The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9305 1.9 christos ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9306 1.9 christos new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9307 1.7 christos fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9308 1.9 christos bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9309 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9310 1.7 christos place:
9311 1.3 christos .
9312 1.3 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9313 1.3 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9314 1.3 christos . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9315 1.3 christos . bctr bctr
9316 1.3 christos . nop b somewhere_else
9317 1.3 christos . b somewhere_else nop
9318 1.3 christos . new_page: new_page:
9319 1.3 christos . */
9320 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9321 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9322 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9323 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9324 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9325 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9326 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9327 1.3 christos continue;
9328 1.3 christos
9329 1.3 christos patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9330 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size);
9331 1.3 christos patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9332 1.3 christos patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9333 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9334 1.3 christos
9335 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL
9336 1.3 christos && rel->r_offset >= offset
9337 1.3 christos && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9338 1.3 christos {
9339 1.3 christos asection *sreloc;
9340 1.3 christos
9341 1.3 christos /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9342 1.3 christos reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9343 1.3 christos location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9344 1.3 christos if (rel + 1 != relend)
9345 1.3 christos {
9346 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9347 1.3 christos
9348 1.3 christos /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9349 1.3 christos memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9350 1.3 christos relend[-1] = tmp;
9351 1.3 christos }
9352 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9353 1.3 christos
9354 1.3 christos /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9355 1.3 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9356 1.3 christos {
9357 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
9358 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9359 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9360 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9361 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9362 1.3 christos break;
9363 1.3 christos default:
9364 1.3 christos break;
9365 1.3 christos }
9366 1.3 christos
9367 1.3 christos /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9368 1.3 christos non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9369 1.3 christos If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9370 1.3 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9371 1.3 christos if (sreloc != NULL)
9372 1.3 christos {
9373 1.3 christos Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9374 1.3 christos bfd_vma soffset;
9375 1.3 christos
9376 1.3 christos slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9377 1.3 christos shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9378 1.3 christos soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9379 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset);
9380 1.3 christos while (slo < shi)
9381 1.3 christos {
9382 1.3 christos Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9383 1.3 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9384 1.3 christos &outrel);
9385 1.3 christos if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9386 1.3 christos slo = srel + 1;
9387 1.3 christos else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9388 1.3 christos shi = srel;
9389 1.3 christos else
9390 1.3 christos {
9391 1.3 christos if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9392 1.9 christos {
9393 1.3 christos memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9394 1.3 christos (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9395 1.3 christos srel = srelend - 1;
9396 1.3 christos }
9397 1.3 christos outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9398 1.3 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9399 1.3 christos (bfd_byte *) srel);
9400 1.3 christos break;
9401 1.3 christos }
9402 1.3 christos }
9403 1.3 christos }
9404 1.3 christos }
9405 1.3 christos else
9406 1.3 christos rel = NULL;
9407 1.3 christos
9408 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9409 1.3 christos && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9410 1.3 christos {
9411 1.3 christos bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9412 1.3 christos
9413 1.3 christos delta += offset - patch_off;
9414 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9415 1.3 christos delta = 0;
9416 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9417 1.3 christos {
9418 1.3 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9419 1.3 christos
9420 1.3 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9421 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9422 1.3 christos insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9423 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9424 1.3 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9425 1.3 christos else
9426 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9427 1.3 christos
9428 1.3 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9429 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9430 1.3 christos && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9431 1.3 christos && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9432 1.3 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9433 1.3 christos }
9434 1.3 christos if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9435 1.3 christos {
9436 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9437 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9438 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9439 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9440 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9441 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9442 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9443 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9444 1.3 christos }
9445 1.3 christos else
9446 1.3 christos {
9447 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL)
9448 1.3 christos {
9449 1.3 christos unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9450 1.3 christos
9451 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9452 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9453 1.3 christos }
9454 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9455 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9456 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9457 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9458 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9459 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9460 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9461 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9462 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9463 1.3 christos B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9464 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9465 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9466 1.1 christos }
9467 1.1 christos }
9468 1.1 christos else
9469 1.7 christos {
9470 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9471 1.10 christos patch_off += 4;
9472 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9473 1.1 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9474 1.7 christos contents + patch_off);
9475 1.7 christos patch_off += 4;
9476 1.1 christos }
9477 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9478 1.1 christos relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9479 1.10 christos }
9480 1.1 christos }
9481 1.1 christos
9482 1.1 christos return ret;
9483 1.10 christos }
9484 1.10 christos
9485 1.1 christos /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9487 1.1 christos
9488 1.1 christos static bool
9489 1.1 christos write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9490 1.7 christos {
9491 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9492 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9493 1.10 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9494 1.1 christos bool doneone;
9495 1.1 christos
9496 1.1 christos doneone = false;
9497 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9498 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9499 1.1 christos {
9500 1.1 christos bool dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
9501 1.1 christos
9502 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
9503 1.1 christos {
9504 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9505 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9506 1.10 christos bfd_vma reloc_index;
9507 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9508 1.1 christos asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9509 1.1 christos
9510 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
9511 1.1 christos reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9512 1.1 christos else
9513 1.1 christos {
9514 1.1 christos reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9515 1.3 christos / htab->plt_slot_size);
9516 1.1 christos if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9517 1.1 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9518 1.1 christos reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9519 1.3 christos }
9520 1.1 christos
9521 1.7 christos /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9522 1.1 christos Set it up. */
9523 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS && dyn)
9524 1.7 christos {
9525 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_offset;
9526 1.7 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9527 1.1 christos
9528 1.1 christos /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9529 1.1 christos got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9530 1.1 christos
9531 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */
9532 1.7 christos plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9533 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9534 1.7 christos
9535 1.7 christos /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9536 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9537 1.7 christos {
9538 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9539 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9540 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9541 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9542 1.7 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9543 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9544 1.1 christos }
9545 1.1 christos else
9546 1.1 christos {
9547 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9548 1.1 christos
9549 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9550 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9551 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9552 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9553 1.7 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9554 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9555 1.1 christos }
9556 1.1 christos
9557 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9558 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9559 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9560 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9561 1.1 christos
9562 1.1 christos /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9563 1.7 christos the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9564 1.7 christos start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9565 1.7 christos low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9566 1.7 christos /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9567 1.7 christos prescaled offset. */
9568 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9569 1.1 christos plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9570 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9571 1.1 christos /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9572 1.7 christos the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9573 1.7 christos instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9574 1.7 christos The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9575 1.7 christos stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9576 1.1 christos offset. */
9577 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9578 1.1 christos (plt_entry[5]
9579 1.1 christos | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9580 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9581 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9582 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9583 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9584 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9585 1.1 christos
9586 1.7 christos /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9587 1.7 christos the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9588 1.1 christos in this PLT entry. */
9589 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9590 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9591 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9592 1.11 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9593 1.11 christos
9594 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9595 1.1 christos {
9596 1.1 christos /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9597 1.7 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9598 1.7 christos + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9599 1.1 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9600 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9601 1.1 christos
9602 1.1 christos /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9603 1.11 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9604 1.11 christos + plt->output_offset
9605 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9606 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9607 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9608 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9609 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
9610 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2));
9611 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9612 1.1 christos
9613 1.1 christos /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9614 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9615 1.11 christos + plt->output_offset
9616 1.11 christos + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9617 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9618 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9619 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9620 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
9621 1.1 christos htab->srelplt2));
9622 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9623 1.1 christos
9624 1.7 christos /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9625 1.7 christos PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9626 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9627 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9628 1.1 christos + got_offset);
9629 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9630 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR32);
9631 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9632 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
9633 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2));
9634 1.7 christos }
9635 1.7 christos
9636 1.7 christos /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9637 1.7 christos In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9638 1.7 christos address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9639 1.7 christos by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9640 1.7 christos the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9641 1.7 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9642 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9643 1.7 christos + got_offset);
9644 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9645 1.7 christos }
9646 1.7 christos else
9647 1.7 christos {
9648 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9649 1.1 christos if (!dyn)
9650 1.7 christos {
9651 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9652 1.7 christos {
9653 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9654 1.1 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9655 1.1 christos }
9656 1.1 christos else
9657 1.7 christos {
9658 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
9659 1.7 christos relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9660 1.7 christos }
9661 1.10 christos if (h->def_regular
9662 1.7 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9663 1.7 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9664 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9665 1.7 christos }
9666 1.7 christos
9667 1.7 christos if (relplt == NULL)
9668 1.7 christos {
9669 1.7 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9670 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9671 1.7 christos }
9672 1.7 christos else
9673 1.7 christos {
9674 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9675 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9676 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset);
9677 1.7 christos
9678 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD || !dyn)
9679 1.7 christos {
9680 1.10 christos /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9681 1.7 christos linker will fill it in. */
9682 1.7 christos }
9683 1.7 christos else
9684 1.7 christos {
9685 1.7 christos bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9686 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9687 1.7 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
9688 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9689 1.7 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9690 1.7 christos }
9691 1.1 christos }
9692 1.7 christos }
9693 1.7 christos
9694 1.7 christos if (relplt != NULL)
9695 1.7 christos {
9696 1.7 christos /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9697 1.1 christos if (!dyn)
9698 1.11 christos {
9699 1.11 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9700 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9701 1.10 christos else
9702 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9703 1.1 christos loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9704 1.10 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9705 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9706 1.1 christos }
9707 1.7 christos else
9708 1.7 christos {
9709 1.10 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9710 1.1 christos loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9711 1.7 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9712 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9713 1.7 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9714 1.7 christos }
9715 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela,
9716 1.1 christos loc, relplt));
9717 1.7 christos }
9718 1.7 christos doneone = true;
9719 1.1 christos }
9720 1.3 christos
9721 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
9722 1.1 christos {
9723 1.1 christos unsigned char *p;
9724 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9725 1.1 christos
9726 1.1 christos if (!dyn)
9727 1.10 christos {
9728 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9729 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9730 1.7 christos else
9731 1.7 christos break;
9732 1.10 christos }
9733 1.7 christos
9734 1.7 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9735 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9736 1.7 christos
9737 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9738 1.7 christos /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9739 1.10 christos break;
9740 1.7 christos }
9741 1.7 christos else
9742 1.7 christos break;
9743 1.7 christos }
9744 1.7 christos return true;
9745 1.7 christos }
9746 1.7 christos
9747 1.7 christos /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9748 1.7 christos
9749 1.7 christos bool
9750 1.7 christos ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9751 1.7 christos {
9752 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9753 1.7 christos bfd *ibfd;
9754 1.7 christos
9755 1.7 christos if (!htab)
9756 1.7 christos return true;
9757 1.7 christos
9758 1.7 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9759 1.7 christos
9760 1.7 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9761 1.7 christos {
9762 1.7 christos bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9763 1.7 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9764 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9765 1.7 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9766 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9767 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9768 1.7 christos
9769 1.7 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9770 1.7 christos continue;
9771 1.7 christos
9772 1.7 christos local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9773 1.7 christos if (!local_got)
9774 1.7 christos continue;
9775 1.9 christos
9776 1.7 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9777 1.7 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9778 1.7 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9779 1.7 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9780 1.10 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9781 1.7 christos for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9782 1.10 christos for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9783 1.7 christos {
9784 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9785 1.7 christos {
9786 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9787 1.7 christos asection *sym_sec;
9788 1.7 christos asection *plt, *relplt;
9789 1.7 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9790 1.7 christos bfd_vma val;
9791 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9792 1.7 christos unsigned char *p;
9793 1.7 christos
9794 1.7 christos if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9795 1.7 christos lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9796 1.7 christos {
9797 1.7 christos if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9798 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
9799 1.7 christos return false;
9800 1.7 christos }
9801 1.7 christos
9802 1.7 christos val = sym->st_value;
9803 1.7 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9804 1.7 christos val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9805 1.7 christos
9806 1.7 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9807 1.7 christos {
9808 1.7 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9809 1.7 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9810 1.7 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9811 1.7 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9812 1.7 christos }
9813 1.7 christos else
9814 1.7 christos {
9815 1.7 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
9816 1.11 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9817 1.11 christos {
9818 1.7 christos relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9819 1.9 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9820 1.7 christos }
9821 1.7 christos else
9822 1.7 christos {
9823 1.7 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9824 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9825 1.7 christos continue;
9826 1.7 christos }
9827 1.7 christos }
9828 1.7 christos
9829 1.7 christos rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9830 1.7 christos + plt->output_offset
9831 1.7 christos + plt->output_section->vma);
9832 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = val;
9833 1.10 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela,
9834 1.7 christos relplt));
9835 1.7 christos
9836 1.7 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9837 1.7 christos write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9838 1.7 christos }
9839 1.10 christos }
9840 1.7 christos
9841 1.7 christos if (local_syms != NULL
9842 1.7 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9843 1.7 christos {
9844 1.7 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
9845 1.7 christos free (local_syms);
9846 1.7 christos else
9847 1.7 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9848 1.7 christos }
9849 1.7 christos }
9850 1.7 christos return true;
9851 1.7 christos }
9852 1.7 christos
9853 1.7 christos /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9854 1.7 christos dynamic sections here. */
9855 1.7 christos
9856 1.7 christos static bool
9857 1.7 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9858 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
9859 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9860 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9861 1.7 christos {
9862 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9863 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9864 1.7 christos
9865 1.7 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9866 1.7 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9867 1.7 christos h->root.root.string);
9868 1.7 christos #endif
9869 1.7 christos
9870 1.7 christos if (!h->def_regular
9871 1.7 christos || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9872 1.7 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9873 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9874 1.7 christos {
9875 1.7 christos if (!h->def_regular)
9876 1.7 christos {
9877 1.7 christos /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9878 1.7 christos defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9879 1.7 christos there were any relocations where pointer equality
9880 1.7 christos matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9881 1.7 christos make function pointer comparisons work between an
9882 1.7 christos application and shared library), otherwise set it
9883 1.7 christos to zero. */
9884 1.7 christos sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9885 1.7 christos if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9886 1.7 christos sym->st_value = 0;
9887 1.7 christos else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9888 1.7 christos {
9889 1.7 christos /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9890 1.7 christos that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9891 1.7 christos function pointer. */
9892 1.7 christos sym->st_value = 0;
9893 1.7 christos }
9894 1.7 christos }
9895 1.7 christos else
9896 1.1 christos {
9897 1.1 christos /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9898 1.1 christos executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9899 1.1 christos text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9900 1.1 christos allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9901 1.1 christos function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9902 1.1 christos to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9903 1.1 christos relocation. */
9904 1.1 christos sym->st_shndx
9905 1.1 christos = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9906 1.1 christos (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9907 1.1 christos sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9908 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
9909 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9910 1.1 christos }
9911 1.1 christos break;
9912 1.7 christos }
9913 1.7 christos
9914 1.1 christos if (h->needs_copy)
9915 1.7 christos {
9916 1.1 christos asection *s;
9917 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9918 1.1 christos
9919 1.1 christos /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9920 1.1 christos
9921 1.11 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9922 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9923 1.1 christos #endif
9924 1.1 christos
9925 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9926 1.1 christos
9927 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9928 1.10 christos s = htab->relsbss;
9929 1.1 christos else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9930 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9931 1.1 christos else
9932 1.3 christos s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9933 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9934 1.3 christos
9935 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9936 1.3 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9937 1.3 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9938 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, s));
9939 1.3 christos }
9940 1.3 christos
9941 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9942 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9943 1.1 christos #endif
9944 1.1 christos
9945 1.1 christos return true;
9946 1.1 christos }
9947 1.1 christos
9948 1.1 christos static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9950 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9951 1.1 christos const asection *rel_sec,
9952 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9953 1.1 christos {
9954 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9955 1.1 christos
9956 1.10 christos if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9957 1.1 christos return reloc_class_ifunc;
9958 1.1 christos
9959 1.1 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9960 1.1 christos {
9961 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9962 1.1 christos return reloc_class_relative;
9963 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9964 1.10 christos return reloc_class_plt;
9965 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
9966 1.1 christos return reloc_class_copy;
9967 1.1 christos default:
9968 1.1 christos return reloc_class_normal;
9969 1.1 christos }
9970 1.1 christos }
9971 1.7 christos
9972 1.1 christos /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9974 1.1 christos
9975 1.1 christos static bool
9976 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9977 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
9978 1.1 christos {
9979 1.1 christos asection *sdyn;
9980 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9981 1.1 christos bfd_vma got;
9982 1.7 christos bfd *dynobj;
9983 1.1 christos bool ret = true;
9984 1.1 christos
9985 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9986 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9987 1.1 christos #endif
9988 1.1 christos
9989 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9990 1.1 christos dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9991 1.1 christos sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9992 1.1 christos
9993 1.1 christos got = 0;
9994 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9995 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9996 1.10 christos
9997 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9998 1.1 christos {
9999 1.7 christos Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
10000 1.1 christos
10001 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
10002 1.1 christos
10003 1.1 christos dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
10004 1.7 christos dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
10005 1.1 christos for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
10006 1.1 christos {
10007 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
10008 1.7 christos asection *s;
10009 1.1 christos
10010 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
10011 1.1 christos
10012 1.1 christos switch (dyn.d_tag)
10013 1.1 christos {
10014 1.1 christos case DT_PLTGOT:
10015 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
10016 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
10017 1.7 christos else
10018 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
10019 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10020 1.7 christos break;
10021 1.7 christos
10022 1.7 christos case DT_PLTRELSZ:
10023 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
10024 1.7 christos break;
10025 1.1 christos
10026 1.1 christos case DT_JMPREL:
10027 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.srelplt;
10028 1.10 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10029 1.1 christos break;
10030 1.1 christos
10031 1.1 christos case DT_PPC_GOT:
10032 1.1 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
10033 1.1 christos break;
10034 1.1 christos
10035 1.1 christos case DT_TEXTREL:
10036 1.1 christos if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
10037 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
10038 1.7 christos (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
10039 1.7 christos "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
10040 1.1 christos else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
10041 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo
10042 1.7 christos (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
10043 1.1 christos "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
10044 1.1 christos continue;
10045 1.1 christos
10046 1.1 christos default:
10047 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
10048 1.1 christos && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
10049 1.1 christos break;
10050 1.1 christos continue;
10051 1.1 christos }
10052 1.1 christos
10053 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
10054 1.1 christos }
10055 1.1 christos }
10056 1.1 christos
10057 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
10058 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10059 1.1 christos {
10060 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
10061 1.1 christos || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
10062 1.1 christos {
10063 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
10064 1.1 christos
10065 1.1 christos p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
10066 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
10067 1.7 christos {
10068 1.7 christos /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10069 1.7 christos so that a function can easily find the address of
10070 1.7 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10071 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10072 1.1 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10073 1.10 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10074 1.1 christos }
10075 1.1 christos
10076 1.7 christos if (sdyn != NULL)
10077 1.1 christos {
10078 1.1 christos bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10079 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10080 1.10 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10081 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10082 1.7 christos }
10083 1.7 christos }
10084 1.1 christos else
10085 1.7 christos {
10086 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
10087 1.3 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10088 1.1 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10089 1.1 christos (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10090 1.1 christos ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10091 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10092 1.1 christos ret = false;
10093 1.1 christos }
10094 1.1 christos
10095 1.1 christos elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10096 1.1 christos }
10097 1.1 christos
10098 1.1 christos /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10099 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
10100 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10101 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10102 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10103 1.1 christos {
10104 1.1 christos asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10105 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */
10106 1.1 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10107 1.1 christos ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10108 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10109 1.1 christos
10110 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10111 1.1 christos {
10112 1.3 christos bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10113 1.1 christos
10114 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10115 1.1 christos splt->contents + 0);
10116 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10117 1.1 christos splt->contents + 4);
10118 1.1 christos }
10119 1.1 christos else
10120 1.7 christos {
10121 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10122 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10123 1.1 christos }
10124 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10125 1.11 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10126 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10127 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10128 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10129 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10130 1.7 christos
10131 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10132 1.1 christos {
10133 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10134 1.11 christos bfd_byte *loc;
10135 1.1 christos
10136 1.1 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10137 1.1 christos
10138 1.1 christos /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10139 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10140 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10141 1.1 christos + 2);
10142 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10143 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
10144 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2));
10145 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10146 1.1 christos
10147 1.1 christos /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10148 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10149 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10150 1.1 christos + 6);
10151 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10152 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
10153 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2));
10154 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10155 1.1 christos
10156 1.1 christos /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10157 1.1 christos symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10158 1.1 christos in which symbols were output. */
10159 1.1 christos while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10160 1.1 christos {
10161 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10162 1.1 christos
10163 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10164 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10165 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10166 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10167 1.1 christos
10168 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10169 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10170 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10171 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10172 1.1 christos
10173 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10174 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10175 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10176 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10177 1.1 christos }
10178 1.1 christos }
10179 1.1 christos }
10180 1.1 christos
10181 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
10182 1.1 christos && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10183 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10184 1.1 christos {
10185 1.1 christos unsigned char *p;
10186 1.1 christos unsigned char *endp;
10187 1.1 christos bfd_vma res0;
10188 1.1 christos
10189 1.1 christos /*
10190 1.1 christos * PIC glink code is the following:
10191 1.1 christos *
10192 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub.
10193 1.1 christos * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10194 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10195 1.1 christos * mtctr 11
10196 1.1 christos * bctr
10197 1.7 christos *
10198 1.1 christos * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10199 1.7 christos * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10200 1.7 christos * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10201 1.1 christos * res_0: b PLTresolve
10202 1.1 christos * res_1: b PLTresolve
10203 1.7 christos * .
10204 1.1 christos * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10205 1.7 christos * res_n_m3: nop
10206 1.1 christos * res_n_m2: nop
10207 1.1 christos * res_n_m1:
10208 1.1 christos *
10209 1.1 christos * PLTresolve:
10210 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10211 1.1 christos * mflr 0
10212 1.1 christos * bcl 20,31,1f
10213 1.1 christos * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10214 1.1 christos * mflr 12
10215 1.1 christos * mtlr 0
10216 1.1 christos * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10217 1.1 christos * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10218 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10219 1.7 christos * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10220 1.7 christos * mtctr 0
10221 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11
10222 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10223 1.7 christos * bctr
10224 1.7 christos *
10225 1.1 christos * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10226 1.1 christos *
10227 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub.
10228 1.1 christos * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10229 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10230 1.1 christos * mtctr 11
10231 1.1 christos * bctr
10232 1.1 christos *
10233 1.1 christos * The branch table is the same, then comes
10234 1.3 christos *
10235 1.1 christos * PLTresolve:
10236 1.1 christos * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10237 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10238 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10239 1.1 christos * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10240 1.1 christos * mtctr 0
10241 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11
10242 1.1 christos * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10243 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10244 1.1 christos * bctr
10245 1.1 christos */
10246 1.1 christos
10247 1.1 christos /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10248 1.1 christos and perhaps some padding. */
10249 1.3 christos p = htab->glink->contents;
10250 1.3 christos p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10251 1.3 christos endp = htab->glink->contents;
10252 1.3 christos endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10253 1.3 christos while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10254 1.3 christos {
10255 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10256 1.3 christos p += 4;
10257 1.3 christos }
10258 1.3 christos while (p < endp)
10259 1.3 christos {
10260 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10261 1.3 christos p += 4;
10262 1.3 christos }
10263 1.3 christos
10264 1.3 christos res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10265 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10266 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10267 1.3 christos
10268 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10269 1.3 christos {
10270 1.3 christos /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10271 1.3 christos result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10272 1.3 christos glink branch table. */
10273 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10274 1.3 christos bfd_vma page_addr;
10275 1.3 christos bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10276 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10277 1.3 christos
10278 1.3 christos for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10279 1.3 christos page_addr > glink_start;
10280 1.3 christos page_addr -= pagesize)
10281 1.3 christos {
10282 1.1 christos /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10283 1.7 christos bfd_byte *loc;
10284 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
10285 1.1 christos
10286 1.1 christos loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10287 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10288 1.1 christos if (insn == BCTR)
10289 1.1 christos {
10290 1.1 christos /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10291 1.1 christos one other call stub before this one. */
10292 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10293 1.7 christos if (insn == BCTR)
10294 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10295 1.7 christos else
10296 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10297 1.7 christos }
10298 1.7 christos }
10299 1.7 christos }
10300 1.7 christos
10301 1.7 christos /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10302 1.7 christos endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10303 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10304 1.7 christos {
10305 1.7 christos bfd_vma bcl;
10306 1.7 christos
10307 1.7 christos bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10308 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10309 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10310 1.7 christos
10311 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10312 1.7 christos p += 4;
10313 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10314 1.1 christos p += 4;
10315 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10316 1.1 christos p += 4;
10317 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10318 1.7 christos p += 4;
10319 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10320 1.7 christos p += 4;
10321 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10322 1.7 christos p += 4;
10323 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10324 1.7 christos p += 4;
10325 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10326 1.1 christos p += 4;
10327 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10328 1.7 christos {
10329 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10330 1.7 christos p += 4;
10331 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10332 1.7 christos p += 4;
10333 1.7 christos }
10334 1.7 christos else
10335 1.7 christos {
10336 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10337 1.7 christos p += 4;
10338 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10339 1.7 christos p += 4;
10340 1.7 christos }
10341 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10342 1.7 christos p += 4;
10343 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10344 1.7 christos }
10345 1.1 christos else
10346 1.7 christos {
10347 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10348 1.7 christos p += 4;
10349 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10350 1.7 christos p += 4;
10351 1.7 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10352 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10353 1.7 christos else
10354 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10355 1.7 christos p += 4;
10356 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10357 1.7 christos p += 4;
10358 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10359 1.7 christos p += 4;
10360 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10361 1.1 christos p += 4;
10362 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10363 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10364 1.1 christos else
10365 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10366 1.1 christos }
10367 1.1 christos p += 4;
10368 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10369 1.1 christos p += 4;
10370 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10371 1.1 christos p += 4;
10372 1.1 christos while (p < endp)
10373 1.1 christos {
10374 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10375 1.1 christos htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10376 1.1 christos p += 4;
10377 1.1 christos }
10378 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10379 1.1 christos }
10380 1.1 christos
10381 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10382 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10383 1.1 christos {
10384 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10385 1.10 christos bfd_vma val;
10386 1.1 christos
10387 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10388 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */
10389 1.1 christos p += 4;
10390 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */
10391 1.3 christos p += 4;
10392 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. */
10393 1.3 christos val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10394 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10395 1.1 christos val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10396 1.1 christos + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10397 1.1 christos val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10398 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10399 1.3 christos
10400 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10401 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10402 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame,
10403 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10404 1.1 christos return false;
10405 1.1 christos }
10406 1.1 christos
10407 1.1 christos return ret;
10408 1.1 christos }
10409 1.1 christos
10410 1.1 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10412 1.1 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10413 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10414 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10415 1.3 christos #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10416 1.1 christos #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10417 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10418 1.1 christos #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10419 1.1 christos #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10420 1.1 christos #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10421 1.1 christos
10422 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10423 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10424 1.1 christos #endif
10425 1.1 christos
10426 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10427 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10428 1.1 christos #endif
10429 1.1 christos
10430 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10431 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10432 1.7 christos #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10433 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10434 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10435 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10436 1.1 christos
10437 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10438 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10439 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10440 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10441 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10442 1.7 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10443 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10444 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10445 1.1 christos
10446 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10447 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10448 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10449 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10450 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10451 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10452 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10453 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10454 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10455 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10456 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10457 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10458 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10459 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10460 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10461 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10462 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10463 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10464 1.3 christos #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10465 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10466 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10467 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10468 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10469 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10470 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10471 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10472 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10473 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10474 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10475 1.1 christos
10476 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h"
10477 1.1 christos
10478 1.1 christos /* FreeBSD Target */
10479 1.1 christos
10480 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10481 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10482 1.3 christos
10483 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10484 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10485 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10486 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10487 1.1 christos
10488 1.10 christos #undef ELF_OSABI
10489 1.10 christos #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10490 1.10 christos
10491 1.1 christos #undef elf32_bed
10492 1.1 christos #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10493 1.7 christos
10494 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h"
10495 1.1 christos
10496 1.1 christos /* VxWorks Target */
10497 1.1 christos
10498 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10499 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10500 1.1 christos
10501 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10502 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10503 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10504 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10505 1.1 christos
10506 1.1 christos #undef ELF_OSABI
10507 1.1 christos
10508 1.1 christos #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
10509 1.1 christos #define ELF_TARGET_OS is_vxworks
10510 1.1 christos
10511 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10512 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10513 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10514 1.1 christos {
10515 1.7 christos if (sec->name == NULL)
10516 1.1 christos return NULL;
10517 1.1 christos
10518 1.1 christos if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10519 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10520 1.1 christos
10521 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10522 1.1 christos }
10523 1.1 christos
10524 1.1 christos /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10525 1.10 christos appropriately for VxWorks. */
10526 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10527 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10528 1.1 christos {
10529 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10530 1.7 christos
10531 1.1 christos ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10532 1.1 christos if (ret)
10533 1.1 christos {
10534 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10535 1.7 christos = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10536 1.10 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10537 1.1 christos htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10538 1.7 christos htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10539 1.1 christos htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10540 1.1 christos }
10541 1.10 christos return ret;
10542 1.9 christos }
10543 1.1 christos
10544 1.9 christos /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10545 1.9 christos static bool
10546 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10547 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
10548 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10549 1.1 christos const char **namep,
10550 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp,
10551 1.1 christos asection **secp,
10552 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp)
10553 1.1 christos {
10554 1.1 christos if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10555 1.1 christos valp))
10556 1.1 christos return false;
10557 1.1 christos
10558 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10559 1.1 christos }
10560 1.1 christos
10561 1.1 christos static bool
10562 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10563 1.7 christos {
10564 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10565 1.1 christos return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10566 1.1 christos }
10567 1.1 christos
10568 1.1 christos /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10569 1.1 christos define it. */
10570 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10571 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10572 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10573 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10574 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10575 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10576 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10577 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10578 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10579 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10580 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10581 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10582 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10583 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10584 1.1 christos
10585 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10586 1.1 christos
10587 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10588 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10589 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10590 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10591 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10592 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10593 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10594 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10595 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10596 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10597 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10598 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10599 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10600 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10601 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10602 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10603 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10604 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10605
10606 #undef elf32_bed
10607 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10608
10609 #include "elf32-target.h"
10610